Merge from trunk: 215733-215743
[official-gcc.git] / gcc-4_9 / gcc / reload1.c
blob3d735eeeec97ef1d53a335cf5d0e2cc8087f2604
1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
7 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
8 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
9 version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
12 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
13 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
14 for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "tm.h"
25 #include "machmode.h"
26 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
27 #include "rtl-error.h"
28 #include "tm_p.h"
29 #include "obstack.h"
30 #include "insn-config.h"
31 #include "ggc.h"
32 #include "flags.h"
33 #include "function.h"
34 #include "expr.h"
35 #include "optabs.h"
36 #include "regs.h"
37 #include "addresses.h"
38 #include "basic-block.h"
39 #include "df.h"
40 #include "reload.h"
41 #include "recog.h"
42 #include "except.h"
43 #include "tree.h"
44 #include "ira.h"
45 #include "target.h"
46 #include "emit-rtl.h"
47 #include "dumpfile.h"
49 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
50 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
51 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
52 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
53 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
54 that need them.
56 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
57 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
58 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
60 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
61 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
62 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
64 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
65 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
66 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
67 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
68 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
69 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
70 until the process stabilizes.
72 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
73 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
74 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
76 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
77 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
78 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
79 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
80 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
81 into the reload registers. */
83 struct target_reload default_target_reload;
84 #if SWITCHABLE_TARGET
85 struct target_reload *this_target_reload = &default_target_reload;
86 #endif
88 #define spill_indirect_levels \
89 (this_target_reload->x_spill_indirect_levels)
91 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
92 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
93 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
95 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
96 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
97 static regset_head reg_has_output_reload;
99 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
100 in the current insn. */
101 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
103 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
104 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
106 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
107 static short *reg_old_renumber;
109 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
110 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
111 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
112 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
113 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
115 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
116 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
117 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
118 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
120 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid. */
121 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
122 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
123 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
124 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
126 /* Indicate whether the register's current value is one that is not
127 safe to retain across a call, even for registers that are normally
128 call-saved. This is only meaningful for members of reg_reloaded_valid. */
129 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered;
131 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
132 static int n_spills;
134 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
135 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
136 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
137 the proper mode. */
138 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
140 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
141 that was stored after the last time it was used.
142 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
143 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
145 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
146 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
147 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
148 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
150 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
151 indexed by hard reg number,
152 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
153 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
155 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
156 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
158 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
159 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
160 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
161 registers. */
162 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
164 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
165 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
166 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
167 to retry register allocation. */
168 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
170 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
171 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
172 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
174 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
175 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
176 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
177 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
178 is calculated during finish_spills. */
179 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
181 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
182 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
183 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
184 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
185 terminate. */
186 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
188 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
189 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
190 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
191 pseudo is live. */
192 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
194 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
195 marked in this set. */
196 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
198 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
199 a round-robin fashion. */
200 static int last_spill_reg;
202 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
203 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
205 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
206 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
208 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
209 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
211 /* Record which pseudos changed their allocation in finish_spills. */
212 static regset_head changed_allocation_pseudos;
214 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
215 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
216 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
218 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
219 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
220 int reload_first_uid;
222 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
223 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
224 int caller_save_needed;
226 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
227 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
228 int reload_in_progress = 0;
230 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
231 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
232 insn. */
233 static struct obstack reload_obstack;
235 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
236 are allocated first. */
237 static char *reload_startobj;
239 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
240 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
241 static char *reload_firstobj;
243 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
244 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
245 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
247 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
248 examine. */
249 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
251 /* TRUE if we potentially left dead insns in the insn stream and want to
252 run DCE immediately after reload, FALSE otherwise. */
253 static bool need_dce;
255 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
256 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
258 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
259 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
260 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
261 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
263 struct elim_table
265 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
266 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
267 HOST_WIDE_INT initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
268 int can_eliminate; /* Nonzero if this elimination can be done. */
269 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value returned by TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
270 target hook in previous scan over insns
271 made by reload. */
272 HOST_WIDE_INT offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
273 HOST_WIDE_INT previous_offset;/* Offset at end of previous insn. */
274 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
275 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
276 We cannot simply compare the number since
277 we might then spuriously replace a hard
278 register corresponding to a pseudo
279 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
280 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
283 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
285 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
286 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
287 static const struct elim_table_1
289 const int from;
290 const int to;
291 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
293 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
294 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
295 replaced by the stack pointer. */
297 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
298 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
299 #else
300 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
301 #endif
303 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
305 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
306 to their initial offset. If nonzero, we use a new copy of each
307 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
308 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
310 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
311 static int num_eliminable;
312 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
313 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
314 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
316 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
317 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
318 elimination. This information is indexed by the difference of the
319 number of the label and the first label number. We can't offset the
320 pointer itself as this can cause problems on machines with segmented
321 memory. The first table is an array of flags that records whether we
322 have yet encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays,
323 one entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
325 static int first_label_num;
326 static char *offsets_known_at;
327 static HOST_WIDE_INT (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
329 vec<reg_equivs_t, va_gc> *reg_equivs;
331 /* Stack of addresses where an rtx has been changed. We can undo the
332 changes by popping items off the stack and restoring the original
333 value at each location.
335 We use this simplistic undo capability rather than copy_rtx as copy_rtx
336 will not make a deep copy of a normally sharable rtx, such as
337 (const (plus (symbol_ref) (const_int))). If such an expression appears
338 as R1 in gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p, then a shared
339 rtx expression would be changed. See PR 42431. */
341 typedef rtx *rtx_p;
342 static vec<rtx_p> substitute_stack;
344 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
346 static int num_labels;
348 static void replace_pseudos_in (rtx *, enum machine_mode, rtx);
349 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms (void);
350 static void copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *);
351 static void calculate_needs_all_insns (int);
352 static int find_reg (struct insn_chain *, int);
353 static void find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
354 static void select_reload_regs (void);
355 static void delete_caller_save_insns (void);
357 static void spill_failure (rtx, enum reg_class);
358 static void count_spilled_pseudo (int, int, int);
359 static void delete_dead_insn (rtx);
360 static void alter_reg (int, int, bool);
361 static void set_label_offsets (rtx, rtx, int);
362 static void check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx);
363 static void elimination_effects (rtx, enum machine_mode);
364 static rtx eliminate_regs_1 (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, bool, bool);
365 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx, int);
366 static void update_eliminable_offsets (void);
367 static void mark_not_eliminable (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
368 static void set_initial_elim_offsets (void);
369 static bool verify_initial_elim_offsets (void);
370 static void set_initial_label_offsets (void);
371 static void set_offsets_for_label (rtx);
372 static void init_eliminable_invariants (rtx, bool);
373 static void init_elim_table (void);
374 static void free_reg_equiv (void);
375 static void update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *);
376 static bool update_eliminables_and_spill (void);
377 static void elimination_costs_in_insn (rtx);
378 static void spill_hard_reg (unsigned int, int);
379 static int finish_spills (int);
380 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx);
381 static void count_pseudo (int);
382 static void order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *);
383 static void reload_as_needed (int);
384 static void forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
385 static void forget_marked_reloads (regset);
386 static int reload_reg_class_lower (const void *, const void *);
387 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
388 enum machine_mode);
389 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
390 enum machine_mode);
391 static int reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
392 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int, int, int, enum reload_type,
393 rtx, rtx, int, int);
394 static int free_for_value_p (int, enum machine_mode, int, enum reload_type,
395 rtx, rtx, int, int);
396 static int allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *, int, int);
397 static int conflicts_with_override (rtx);
398 static void failed_reload (rtx, int);
399 static int set_reload_reg (int, int);
400 static void choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *, rtx *);
401 static void choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
402 static void emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
403 rtx, int);
404 static void emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
405 int);
406 static void do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
407 static void do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
408 static void emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *);
409 static void delete_output_reload (rtx, int, int, rtx);
410 static void delete_address_reloads (rtx, rtx);
411 static void delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx, rtx, rtx);
412 static void inc_for_reload (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
413 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
414 static void add_auto_inc_notes (rtx, rtx);
415 #endif
416 static void substitute (rtx *, const_rtx, rtx);
417 static bool gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int, int);
418 static int reloads_conflict (int, int);
419 static rtx gen_reload (rtx, rtx, int, enum reload_type);
420 static rtx emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx);
422 /* Initialize the reload pass. This is called at the beginning of compilation
423 and may be called again if the target is reinitialized. */
425 void
426 init_reload (void)
428 int i;
430 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
431 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
432 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
434 rtx tem
435 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
436 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
437 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
438 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
439 gen_int_mode (4, Pmode)));
440 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
442 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
444 spill_indirect_levels++;
445 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
448 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
450 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
451 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
453 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
455 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
457 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
458 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
459 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
461 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
462 tem = plus_constant (Pmode, tem, 4);
464 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
466 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
467 break;
471 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
472 if (reload_startobj == NULL)
474 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
475 reload_startobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
478 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
479 INIT_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
480 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
483 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
484 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
486 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
487 struct insn_chain *
488 new_insn_chain (void)
490 struct insn_chain *c;
492 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
494 c = XOBNEW (&reload_obstack, struct insn_chain);
495 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
496 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
498 else
500 c = unused_insn_chains;
501 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
503 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
504 c->need_operand_change = 0;
505 c->need_reload = 0;
506 c->need_elim = 0;
507 return c;
510 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
511 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
513 void
514 compute_use_by_pseudos (HARD_REG_SET *to, regset from)
516 unsigned int regno;
517 reg_set_iterator rsi;
519 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno, rsi)
521 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
523 if (r < 0)
525 /* reload_combine uses the information from DF_LIVE_IN,
526 which might still contain registers that have not
527 actually been allocated since they have an
528 equivalence. */
529 gcc_assert (ira_conflicts_p || reload_completed);
531 else
532 add_to_hard_reg_set (to, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno), r);
536 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
537 equivalences. */
539 static void
540 replace_pseudos_in (rtx *loc, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx usage)
542 rtx x = *loc;
543 enum rtx_code code;
544 const char *fmt;
545 int i, j;
547 if (! x)
548 return;
550 code = GET_CODE (x);
551 if (code == REG)
553 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
555 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
556 return;
558 x = eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, usage, true, false);
559 if (x != *loc)
561 *loc = x;
562 replace_pseudos_in (loc, mem_mode, usage);
563 return;
566 if (reg_equiv_constant (regno))
567 *loc = reg_equiv_constant (regno);
568 else if (reg_equiv_invariant (regno))
569 *loc = reg_equiv_invariant (regno);
570 else if (reg_equiv_mem (regno))
571 *loc = reg_equiv_mem (regno);
572 else if (reg_equiv_address (regno))
573 *loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), reg_equiv_address (regno));
574 else
576 gcc_assert (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[regno])
577 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != regno);
578 *loc = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
581 return;
583 else if (code == MEM)
585 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), usage);
586 return;
589 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
590 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
591 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
592 if (*fmt == 'e')
593 replace_pseudos_in (&XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, usage);
594 else if (*fmt == 'E')
595 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
596 replace_pseudos_in (& XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, usage);
599 /* Determine if the current function has an exception receiver block
600 that reaches the exit block via non-exceptional edges */
602 static bool
603 has_nonexceptional_receiver (void)
605 edge e;
606 edge_iterator ei;
607 basic_block *tos, *worklist, bb;
609 /* If we're not optimizing, then just err on the safe side. */
610 if (!optimize)
611 return true;
613 /* First determine which blocks can reach exit via normal paths. */
614 tos = worklist = XNEWVEC (basic_block, n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) + 1);
616 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
617 bb->flags &= ~BB_REACHABLE;
619 /* Place the exit block on our worklist. */
620 EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun)->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
621 *tos++ = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun);
623 /* Iterate: find everything reachable from what we've already seen. */
624 while (tos != worklist)
626 bb = *--tos;
628 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
629 if (!(e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL))
631 basic_block src = e->src;
633 if (!(src->flags & BB_REACHABLE))
635 src->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
636 *tos++ = src;
640 free (worklist);
642 /* Now see if there's a reachable block with an exceptional incoming
643 edge. */
644 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
645 if (bb->flags & BB_REACHABLE && bb_has_abnormal_pred (bb))
646 return true;
648 /* No exceptional block reached exit unexceptionally. */
649 return false;
652 /* Grow (or allocate) the REG_EQUIVS array from its current size (which may be
653 zero elements) to MAX_REG_NUM elements.
655 Initialize all new fields to NULL and update REG_EQUIVS_SIZE. */
656 void
657 grow_reg_equivs (void)
659 int old_size = vec_safe_length (reg_equivs);
660 int max_regno = max_reg_num ();
661 int i;
662 reg_equivs_t ze;
664 memset (&ze, 0, sizeof (reg_equivs_t));
665 vec_safe_reserve (reg_equivs, max_regno);
666 for (i = old_size; i < max_regno; i++)
667 reg_equivs->quick_insert (i, ze);
671 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
673 /* The current basic block while in calculate_elim_costs_all_insns. */
674 static basic_block elim_bb;
676 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
677 static int something_needs_elimination;
678 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
679 static int something_needs_operands_changed;
680 /* Set by alter_regs if we spilled a register to the stack. */
681 static bool something_was_spilled;
683 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
684 static int failure;
686 /* Temporary array of pseudo-register number. */
687 static int *temp_pseudo_reg_arr;
689 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
691 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
693 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
694 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
695 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
696 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
697 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
699 Return value is TRUE if reload likely left dead insns in the
700 stream and a DCE pass should be run to elimiante them. Else the
701 return value is FALSE. */
703 bool
704 reload (rtx first, int global)
706 int i, n;
707 rtx insn;
708 struct elim_table *ep;
709 basic_block bb;
710 bool inserted;
712 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
713 init_recog ();
715 failure = 0;
717 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
719 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
720 is not something that needs reloading. */
721 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
723 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
724 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
726 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
727 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
728 clear_secondary_mem ();
729 #endif
731 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
732 memset (spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
733 memset (spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
735 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
736 are needed. */
737 init_save_areas ();
739 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
740 as homes for pseudo registers.
741 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
742 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
743 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
744 mark_home_live (i);
746 /* A function that has a nonlocal label that can reach the exit
747 block via non-exceptional paths must save all call-saved
748 registers. */
749 if (cfun->has_nonlocal_label
750 && has_nonexceptional_receiver ())
751 crtl->saves_all_registers = 1;
753 if (crtl->saves_all_registers)
754 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
755 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
756 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
758 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
759 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
760 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
761 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
763 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
764 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
765 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
766 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
768 grow_reg_equivs ();
769 reg_old_renumber = XCNEWVEC (short, max_regno);
770 memcpy (reg_old_renumber, reg_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
771 pseudo_forbidden_regs = XNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
772 pseudo_previous_regs = XCNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
774 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
776 init_eliminable_invariants (first, true);
777 init_elim_table ();
779 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number. Assign
780 stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
781 Do not touch virtual registers. */
783 temp_pseudo_reg_arr = XNEWVEC (int, max_regno - LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER - 1);
784 for (n = 0, i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
785 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
787 if (ira_conflicts_p)
788 /* Ask IRA to order pseudo-registers for better stack slot
789 sharing. */
790 ira_sort_regnos_for_alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n, reg_max_ref_width);
792 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
793 alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr[i], -1, false);
795 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
796 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
797 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
798 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
799 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
800 cannot be done. */
801 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
802 if (INSN_P (insn))
803 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
805 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
807 insns_need_reload = 0;
808 something_needs_elimination = 0;
810 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
811 last_spill_reg = -1;
813 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
814 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
815 /* There can be multiple ways to eliminate a register;
816 they should be listed adjacently.
817 Elimination for any register fails only if all possible ways fail. */
818 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; )
820 int from = ep->from;
821 int can_eliminate = 0;
824 can_eliminate |= ep->can_eliminate;
825 ep++;
827 while (ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS] && ep->from == from);
828 if (! can_eliminate)
829 spill_hard_reg (from, 1);
832 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
833 if (frame_pointer_needed)
834 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
835 #endif
836 finish_spills (global);
838 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
839 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
840 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
841 reload_in_progress = 1;
843 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
844 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
845 for (;;)
847 int something_changed;
848 int did_spill;
849 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
851 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
852 something_was_spilled = false;
854 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
855 set_initial_label_offsets ();
857 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
858 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
859 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
860 is the normal case.
862 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
863 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
865 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
866 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
867 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
868 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
869 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
870 valid as an address register.
872 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
873 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
874 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
875 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
876 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
878 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
879 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
881 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
882 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (i))
884 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc (i), VOIDmode,
885 NULL_RTX);
887 if (strict_memory_address_addr_space_p
888 (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), XEXP (x, 0),
889 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x)))
890 reg_equiv_mem (i) = x, reg_equiv_address (i) = 0;
891 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
892 || (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
893 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
894 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
895 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
896 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
897 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
898 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
899 reg_equiv_address (i) = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem (i) = 0;
900 else
902 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
903 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
904 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
905 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
906 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
907 the loop. */
908 reg_equiv_memory_loc (i) = 0;
909 reg_equiv_init (i) = 0;
910 alter_reg (i, -1, true);
914 if (caller_save_needed)
915 setup_save_areas ();
917 if (starting_frame_size && crtl->stack_alignment_needed)
919 /* If we have a stack frame, we must align it now. The
920 stack size may be a part of the offset computation for
921 register elimination. So if this changes the stack size,
922 then repeat the elimination bookkeeping. We don't
923 realign when there is no stack, as that will cause a
924 stack frame when none is needed should
925 STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET not be already aligned to
926 STACK_BOUNDARY. */
927 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, crtl->stack_alignment_needed);
929 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
930 if (something_was_spilled || starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
932 update_eliminables_and_spill ();
933 continue;
936 if (caller_save_needed)
938 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
939 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
940 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
943 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
945 if (! ira_conflicts_p)
946 /* Don't do it for IRA. We need this info because we don't
947 change live_throughout and dead_or_set for chains when IRA
948 is used. */
949 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
951 did_spill = 0;
953 something_changed = 0;
955 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
956 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
957 if (something_was_spilled || starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
958 something_changed = 1;
960 /* Even if the frame size remained the same, we might still have
961 changed elimination offsets, e.g. if find_reloads called
962 force_const_mem requiring the back end to allocate a constant
963 pool base register that needs to be saved on the stack. */
964 else if (!verify_initial_elim_offsets ())
965 something_changed = 1;
967 if (update_eliminables_and_spill ())
969 did_spill = 1;
970 something_changed = 1;
973 select_reload_regs ();
974 if (failure)
975 goto failed;
977 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
978 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
980 if (! something_changed)
981 break;
983 if (caller_save_needed)
984 delete_caller_save_insns ();
986 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
989 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
990 done. */
991 if (global)
992 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
993 if (ep->can_eliminate)
994 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
996 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
997 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
998 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
999 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1000 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1001 there and that is incorrect. */
1003 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1005 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init (i) != 0)
1007 rtx list;
1008 for (list = reg_equiv_init (i); list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
1010 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
1012 /* If we already deleted the insn or if it may trap, we can't
1013 delete it. The latter case shouldn't happen, but can
1014 if an insn has a variable address, gets a REG_EH_REGION
1015 note added to it, and then gets converted into a load
1016 from a constant address. */
1017 if (NOTE_P (equiv_insn)
1018 || can_throw_internal (equiv_insn))
1020 else if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
1021 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1022 else
1023 SET_INSN_DELETED (equiv_insn);
1028 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1029 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1030 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1032 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1033 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1035 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1037 reload_as_needed (global);
1039 gcc_assert (old_frame_size == get_frame_size ());
1041 gcc_assert (verify_initial_elim_offsets ());
1044 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1045 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1046 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1047 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1048 pseudo. */
1050 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1051 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
1052 bitmap_clear_bit (df_get_live_in (bb), HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1054 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill
1055 regs. */
1056 failed:
1058 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
1059 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1060 reload_in_progress = 0;
1062 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1063 their equivalent memory references.
1064 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1065 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1067 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1068 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1069 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1070 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1072 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1074 rtx addr = 0;
1076 if (reg_equiv_mem (i))
1077 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem (i), 0);
1079 if (reg_equiv_address (i))
1080 addr = reg_equiv_address (i);
1082 if (addr)
1084 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1086 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1088 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1089 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1090 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1091 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc (i))
1092 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (reg, reg_equiv_memory_loc (i));
1093 else
1094 MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
1095 MEM_NOTRAP_P (reg) = 1;
1097 else if (reg_equiv_mem (i))
1098 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem (i), 0) = addr;
1101 /* We don't want complex addressing modes in debug insns
1102 if simpler ones will do, so delegitimize equivalences
1103 in debug insns. */
1104 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS && reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1106 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1107 rtx equiv = 0;
1108 df_ref use, next;
1110 if (reg_equiv_constant (i))
1111 equiv = reg_equiv_constant (i);
1112 else if (reg_equiv_invariant (i))
1113 equiv = reg_equiv_invariant (i);
1114 else if (reg && MEM_P (reg))
1115 equiv = targetm.delegitimize_address (reg);
1116 else if (reg && REG_P (reg) && (int)REGNO (reg) != i)
1117 equiv = reg;
1119 if (equiv == reg)
1120 continue;
1122 for (use = DF_REG_USE_CHAIN (i); use; use = next)
1124 insn = DF_REF_INSN (use);
1126 /* Make sure the next ref is for a different instruction,
1127 so that we're not affected by the rescan. */
1128 next = DF_REF_NEXT_REG (use);
1129 while (next && DF_REF_INSN (next) == insn)
1130 next = DF_REF_NEXT_REG (next);
1132 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
1134 if (!equiv)
1136 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
1137 df_insn_rescan_debug_internal (insn);
1139 else
1140 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn)
1141 = simplify_replace_rtx (INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn),
1142 reg, equiv);
1148 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1149 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1150 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1151 reload_completed = 1;
1153 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1154 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1155 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns, except those that refer to the return
1156 value and the special mem:BLK CLOBBERs added to prevent the scheduler
1157 from misarranging variable-array code, and simplify (subreg (reg))
1158 operands. Strip and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved
1159 around. */
1161 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1162 if (INSN_P (insn))
1164 rtx *pnote;
1166 if (CALL_P (insn))
1167 replace_pseudos_in (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
1168 VOIDmode, CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
1170 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1171 /* We mark with QImode USEs introduced by reload itself. */
1172 && (GET_MODE (insn) == QImode
1173 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX)))
1174 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1175 && (!MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1176 || GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != BLKmode
1177 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)) != SCRATCH
1178 && XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
1179 != stack_pointer_rtx))
1180 && (!REG_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1181 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1183 delete_insn (insn);
1184 continue;
1187 /* Some CLOBBERs may survive until here and still reference unassigned
1188 pseudos with const equivalent, which may in turn cause ICE in later
1189 passes if the reference remains in place. */
1190 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
1191 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0),
1192 VOIDmode, PATTERN (insn));
1194 /* Discard obvious no-ops, even without -O. This optimization
1195 is fast and doesn't interfere with debugging. */
1196 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
1197 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
1198 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1199 && REG_P (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))
1200 && (REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1201 == REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))))
1203 delete_insn (insn);
1204 continue;
1207 pnote = &REG_NOTES (insn);
1208 while (*pnote != 0)
1210 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1211 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1212 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC)
1213 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1214 else
1215 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1218 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1219 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1220 #endif
1222 /* Simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1223 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1225 /* Clean up invalid ASMs so that they don't confuse later passes.
1226 See PR 21299. */
1227 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1229 extract_insn (insn);
1230 if (!constrain_operands (1))
1232 error_for_asm (insn,
1233 "%<asm%> operand has impossible constraints");
1234 delete_insn (insn);
1235 continue;
1240 /* If we are doing generic stack checking, give a warning if this
1241 function's frame size is larger than we expect. */
1242 if (flag_stack_check == GENERIC_STACK_CHECK)
1244 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1245 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1247 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1248 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1249 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1251 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1253 warning (0, "frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1254 if (! verbose_warned)
1256 warning (0, "try reducing the number of local variables");
1257 verbose_warned = 1;
1262 free (temp_pseudo_reg_arr);
1264 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1265 free_reg_equiv ();
1267 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1268 free (reg_old_renumber);
1269 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1270 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1272 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1273 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1274 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1276 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1277 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1278 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1280 inserted = fixup_abnormal_edges ();
1282 /* We've possibly turned single trapping insn into multiple ones. */
1283 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
1285 sbitmap blocks;
1286 blocks = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
1287 bitmap_ones (blocks);
1288 find_many_sub_basic_blocks (blocks);
1289 sbitmap_free (blocks);
1292 if (inserted)
1293 commit_edge_insertions ();
1295 /* Replacing pseudos with their memory equivalents might have
1296 created shared rtx. Subsequent passes would get confused
1297 by this, so unshare everything here. */
1298 unshare_all_rtl_again (first);
1300 #ifdef STACK_BOUNDARY
1301 /* init_emit has set the alignment of the hard frame pointer
1302 to STACK_BOUNDARY. It is very likely no longer valid if
1303 the hard frame pointer was used for register allocation. */
1304 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
1305 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) = BITS_PER_UNIT;
1306 #endif
1308 substitute_stack.release ();
1310 gcc_assert (bitmap_empty_p (&spilled_pseudos));
1312 reload_completed = !failure;
1314 return need_dce;
1317 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1318 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1319 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1320 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1321 register sets to avoid this.
1322 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1324 static void
1325 maybe_fix_stack_asms (void)
1327 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1328 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1329 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1330 struct insn_chain *chain;
1332 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1334 int i, noperands;
1335 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1336 rtx pat;
1338 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1339 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1340 continue;
1341 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1342 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1343 continue;
1345 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1346 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1348 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1349 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1351 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1352 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1353 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1356 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1357 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1358 constraints, operand_mode, NULL);
1360 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1361 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1363 const char *p = constraints[i];
1364 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1365 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1366 ALLOWED. */
1367 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1369 for (;;)
1371 char c = *p;
1373 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1375 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1376 class, and reset the class. */
1377 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1378 cls = NO_REGS;
1379 p++;
1380 if (c == '#')
1381 do {
1382 c = *p++;
1383 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1384 if (c == '\0')
1385 break;
1386 continue;
1389 switch (c)
1391 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1392 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '<':
1393 case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E': case 'F':
1394 case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I': case 'J':
1395 case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
1396 case TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT:
1397 break;
1399 case 'p':
1400 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1401 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC,
1402 ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1403 break;
1405 case 'g':
1406 case 'r':
1407 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1408 break;
1410 default:
1411 if (EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (c, p))
1412 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1413 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC,
1414 ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1415 else
1416 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1417 [(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (c, p)];
1419 p += CONSTRAINT_LEN (c, p);
1422 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1423 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1424 out of the life information. */
1425 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1426 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1427 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1429 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1430 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1434 #endif
1437 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1438 of CHAIN. */
1439 static void
1440 copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *chain)
1442 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1443 chain->rld = XOBNEWVEC (&reload_obstack, struct reload, n_reloads);
1444 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1445 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1448 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1449 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1450 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1451 static void
1452 calculate_needs_all_insns (int global)
1454 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1455 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1457 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1459 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1460 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1462 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1464 next = chain->next;
1466 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1467 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1468 chain->need_elim = 0;
1469 chain->need_reload = 0;
1470 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1472 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1473 include REG_LABEL_OPERAND and REG_LABEL_TARGET), we need to see
1474 what effects this has on the known offsets at labels. */
1476 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn) || JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn)
1477 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1478 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1480 if (INSN_P (insn))
1482 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1483 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1484 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1485 int did_elimination = 0;
1486 int operands_changed = 0;
1487 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1489 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1490 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1491 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1492 && (reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)))
1493 || (reg_equiv_invariant (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)))))
1494 && reg_equiv_init (REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
1495 continue;
1497 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1498 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1499 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1501 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1502 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1503 global, spill_reg_order);
1505 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1506 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1507 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1508 anyway, so discard it now.
1509 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1510 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1511 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1512 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1514 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1515 if (set
1517 ((SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1518 && REG_P (SET_SRC (set))
1519 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1520 || (REG_P (SET_SRC (set)) && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1521 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] < 0
1522 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1523 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SET_SRC (set))) != NULL
1524 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SET_DEST (set))) != NULL
1525 && rtx_equal_p (reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SET_SRC (set))),
1526 reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)))))))
1528 if (ira_conflicts_p)
1529 /* Inform IRA about the insn deletion. */
1530 ira_mark_memory_move_deletion (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)),
1531 REGNO (SET_SRC (set)));
1532 delete_insn (insn);
1533 /* Delete it from the reload chain. */
1534 if (chain->prev)
1535 chain->prev->next = next;
1536 else
1537 reload_insn_chain = next;
1538 if (next)
1539 next->prev = chain->prev;
1540 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1541 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1542 continue;
1545 if (num_eliminable)
1546 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1548 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1549 register eliminations. */
1550 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1551 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1552 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1554 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1555 if (did_elimination)
1557 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1558 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1559 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1560 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1561 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1564 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1566 if (n_reloads != 0)
1568 copy_reloads (chain);
1569 *pprev_reload = chain;
1570 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1574 *pprev_reload = 0;
1577 /* This function is called from the register allocator to set up estimates
1578 for the cost of eliminating pseudos which have REG_EQUIV equivalences to
1579 an invariant. The structure is similar to calculate_needs_all_insns. */
1581 void
1582 calculate_elim_costs_all_insns (void)
1584 int *reg_equiv_init_cost;
1585 basic_block bb;
1586 int i;
1588 reg_equiv_init_cost = XCNEWVEC (int, max_regno);
1589 init_elim_table ();
1590 init_eliminable_invariants (get_insns (), false);
1592 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
1593 set_initial_label_offsets ();
1595 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
1597 rtx insn;
1598 elim_bb = bb;
1600 FOR_BB_INSNS (bb, insn)
1602 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1603 include REG_LABEL_OPERAND and REG_LABEL_TARGET), we need to see
1604 what effects this has on the known offsets at labels. */
1606 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn) || JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn)
1607 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1608 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1610 if (INSN_P (insn))
1612 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1614 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1615 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1616 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1617 && (reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)))
1618 || reg_equiv_invariant (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)))))
1620 unsigned regno = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
1621 rtx init = reg_equiv_init (regno);
1622 if (init)
1624 rtx t = eliminate_regs_1 (SET_SRC (set), VOIDmode, insn,
1625 false, true);
1626 int cost = set_src_cost (t, optimize_bb_for_speed_p (bb));
1627 int freq = REG_FREQ_FROM_BB (bb);
1629 reg_equiv_init_cost[regno] = cost * freq;
1630 continue;
1633 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1634 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1635 elimination_costs_in_insn (insn);
1637 if (num_eliminable)
1638 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1642 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1644 if (reg_equiv_invariant (i))
1646 if (reg_equiv_init (i))
1648 int cost = reg_equiv_init_cost[i];
1649 if (dump_file)
1650 fprintf (dump_file,
1651 "Reg %d has equivalence, initial gains %d\n", i, cost);
1652 if (cost != 0)
1653 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (i, cost);
1655 else
1657 if (dump_file)
1658 fprintf (dump_file,
1659 "Reg %d had equivalence, but can't be eliminated\n",
1661 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (i, 0);
1666 free (reg_equiv_init_cost);
1667 free (offsets_known_at);
1668 free (offsets_at);
1669 offsets_at = NULL;
1670 offsets_known_at = NULL;
1673 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1674 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1676 static int
1677 reload_reg_class_lower (const void *r1p, const void *r2p)
1679 int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1680 int t;
1682 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1683 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1684 if (t != 0)
1685 return t;
1687 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1688 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].rclass] == 1)
1689 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].rclass] == 1));
1690 if (t != 0)
1691 return t;
1693 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1694 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1695 if (t != 0)
1696 return t;
1698 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1699 t = (int) rld[r1].rclass - (int) rld[r2].rclass;
1700 if (t != 0)
1701 return t;
1703 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1704 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1705 return r1 - r2;
1708 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1709 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1711 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1712 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1713 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1714 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1716 /* Map of hard regno to pseudo regno currently occupying the hard
1717 reg. */
1718 static int hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1720 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1722 static void
1723 count_pseudo (int reg)
1725 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1726 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1727 int nregs;
1729 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA is used. */
1730 if (ira_conflicts_p && r < 0)
1731 return;
1733 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1734 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg))
1735 return;
1737 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1739 gcc_assert (r >= 0);
1741 spill_add_cost[r] += freq;
1742 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1743 while (nregs-- > 0)
1745 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = reg;
1746 spill_cost[r + nregs] += freq;
1750 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1751 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1753 static void
1754 order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *chain)
1756 unsigned i;
1757 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1758 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1759 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1761 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1763 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1764 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1765 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1766 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[i] = -1;
1768 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1769 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1770 that are live in or across this insn. */
1772 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1773 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1774 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1775 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1777 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1778 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1779 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1781 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1782 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1784 count_pseudo (i);
1786 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1787 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1789 count_pseudo (i);
1791 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1794 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1795 be processed. */
1796 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1798 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1799 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1801 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1802 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1803 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1804 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1806 static void
1807 count_spilled_pseudo (int spilled, int spilled_nregs, int reg)
1809 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1810 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1811 int nregs;
1813 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA is used. */
1814 if (ira_conflicts_p && r < 0)
1815 return;
1817 gcc_assert (r >= 0);
1819 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1821 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1822 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1823 return;
1825 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1827 spill_add_cost[r] -= freq;
1828 while (nregs-- > 0)
1830 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = -1;
1831 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= freq;
1835 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1837 static int
1838 find_reg (struct insn_chain *chain, int order)
1840 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1841 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1842 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1843 int best_reg = -1;
1844 unsigned int i, j, n;
1845 int k;
1846 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1847 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1848 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1849 static int regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1850 static int best_regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1852 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1853 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1854 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->rclass]);
1856 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1857 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1859 int other = reload_order[k];
1861 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1862 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1863 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1866 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1868 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1869 unsigned int regno = reg_alloc_order[i];
1870 #else
1871 unsigned int regno = i;
1872 #endif
1874 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1875 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1876 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1878 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1879 int ok = 1;
1880 unsigned int this_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rl->mode];
1882 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1884 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1885 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1886 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1887 ok = 0;
1889 if (! ok)
1890 continue;
1892 if (ira_conflicts_p)
1894 /* Ask IRA to find a better pseudo-register for
1895 spilling. */
1896 for (n = j = 0; j < this_nregs; j++)
1898 int r = hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[regno + j];
1900 if (r < 0)
1901 continue;
1902 if (n == 0 || regno_pseudo_regs[n - 1] != r)
1903 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = r;
1905 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = -1;
1906 if (best_reg < 0
1907 || ira_better_spill_reload_regno_p (regno_pseudo_regs,
1908 best_regno_pseudo_regs,
1909 rl->in, rl->out,
1910 chain->insn))
1912 best_reg = regno;
1913 for (j = 0;; j++)
1915 best_regno_pseudo_regs[j] = regno_pseudo_regs[j];
1916 if (regno_pseudo_regs[j] < 0)
1917 break;
1920 continue;
1923 if (rl->in && REG_P (rl->in) && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1924 this_cost--;
1925 if (rl->out && REG_P (rl->out) && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1926 this_cost--;
1927 if (this_cost < best_cost
1928 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1929 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1930 || (this_cost == best_cost
1931 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1932 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1933 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1934 #else
1935 && call_used_regs[regno]
1936 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1937 #endif
1940 best_reg = regno;
1941 best_cost = this_cost;
1945 if (best_reg == -1)
1946 return 0;
1948 if (dump_file)
1949 fprintf (dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1951 rl->nregs = hard_regno_nregs[best_reg][rl->mode];
1952 rl->regno = best_reg;
1954 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1955 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1957 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1960 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1961 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1963 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1966 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1968 gcc_assert (spill_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1969 gcc_assert (spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1970 gcc_assert (hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[best_reg + i] == -1);
1971 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1973 return 1;
1976 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1977 is given by CHAIN.
1978 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1979 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1980 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1982 static void
1983 find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
1985 int i;
1987 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1988 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1989 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1990 that provided the reload registers. */
1991 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1993 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1994 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1996 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1997 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1998 chain->rld[i].nregs
1999 = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)];
2001 else
2002 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
2003 reload_order[i] = i;
2006 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
2007 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
2009 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
2011 if (dump_file)
2012 fprintf (dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
2014 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
2016 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
2018 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
2020 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
2022 int r = reload_order[i];
2024 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
2025 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
2026 && ! rld[r].optional
2027 && rld[r].regno == -1)
2028 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
2030 if (dump_file)
2031 fprintf (dump_file, "reload failure for reload %d\n", r);
2032 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].rclass);
2033 failure = 1;
2034 return;
2038 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2039 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2041 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
2044 static void
2045 select_reload_regs (void)
2047 struct insn_chain *chain;
2049 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
2050 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
2051 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
2052 find_reload_regs (chain);
2055 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
2056 this iteration. */
2057 static void
2058 delete_caller_save_insns (void)
2060 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
2062 while (c != 0)
2064 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
2066 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
2067 rtx insn = c->insn;
2069 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
2070 reload_insn_chain = next;
2071 delete_insn (insn);
2073 if (next)
2074 next->prev = c->prev;
2075 if (c->prev)
2076 c->prev->next = next;
2077 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
2078 unused_insn_chains = c;
2079 c = next;
2081 if (c != 0)
2082 c = c->next;
2086 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
2087 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
2089 static void
2090 spill_failure (rtx insn, enum reg_class rclass)
2092 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
2093 error_for_asm (insn, "can%'t find a register in class %qs while "
2094 "reloading %<asm%>",
2095 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2096 else
2098 error ("unable to find a register to spill in class %qs",
2099 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2101 if (dump_file)
2103 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
2104 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
2106 fatal_insn ("this is the insn:", insn);
2110 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
2111 data that is dead in INSN. */
2113 static void
2114 delete_dead_insn (rtx insn)
2116 rtx prev = prev_active_insn (insn);
2117 rtx prev_dest;
2119 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn make
2120 a note that we want to run DCE immediately after reload.
2122 We used to delete the previous insn & recurse, but that's wrong for
2123 block local equivalences. Instead of trying to figure out the exact
2124 circumstances where we can delete the potentially dead insns, just
2125 let DCE do the job. */
2126 if (prev && BLOCK_FOR_INSN (prev) == BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn)
2127 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
2128 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), REG_P (prev_dest))
2129 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
2130 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
2131 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
2132 need_dce = 1;
2134 SET_INSN_DELETED (insn);
2137 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
2138 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
2140 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
2141 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
2142 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
2143 can share one stack slot. */
2145 static void
2146 alter_reg (int i, int from_reg, bool dont_share_p)
2148 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
2149 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
2150 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
2151 return;
2153 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
2154 ignore it. */
2155 if (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
2156 return;
2158 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
2159 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
2160 SET_REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i],
2161 reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i);
2163 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
2164 allocate a stack slot for it. */
2166 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
2167 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
2168 && reg_equiv_constant (i) == 0
2169 && (reg_equiv_invariant (i) == 0
2170 || reg_equiv_init (i) == 0)
2171 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (i) == 0)
2173 rtx x = NULL_RTX;
2174 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2175 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
2176 unsigned int inherent_align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
2177 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
2178 unsigned int min_align = reg_max_ref_width[i] * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2179 int adjust = 0;
2181 something_was_spilled = true;
2183 if (ira_conflicts_p)
2185 /* Mark the spill for IRA. */
2186 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
2187 if (!dont_share_p)
2188 x = ira_reuse_stack_slot (i, inherent_size, total_size);
2191 if (x)
2194 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
2195 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
2196 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
2198 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
2199 enough inherent space and enough total space.
2200 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
2201 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
2202 else if (from_reg == -1 || (!dont_share_p && ira_conflicts_p))
2204 rtx stack_slot;
2206 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
2207 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2208 min_align > inherent_align
2209 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2211 stack_slot = x;
2213 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2214 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2215 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2216 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2218 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
2219 if (adjust)
2220 stack_slot
2221 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2222 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2223 MODE_INT, 1),
2224 adjust);
2227 if (! dont_share_p && ira_conflicts_p)
2228 /* Inform IRA about allocation a new stack slot. */
2229 ira_mark_new_stack_slot (stack_slot, i, total_size);
2232 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
2233 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
2234 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
2235 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2236 >= inherent_size)
2237 && MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) >= min_align)
2238 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
2240 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2241 else
2243 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2244 and for total size. */
2245 rtx stack_slot;
2247 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2249 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2250 > inherent_size)
2251 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2252 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
2253 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
2254 if (MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) > min_align)
2255 min_align = MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2258 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2259 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2260 min_align > inherent_align
2261 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2262 stack_slot = x;
2264 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2265 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2266 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2267 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2269 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
2270 if (adjust)
2271 stack_slot
2272 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2273 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2274 MODE_INT, 1),
2275 adjust);
2278 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
2279 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
2282 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2283 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2284 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
2285 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
2287 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2288 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2289 x = adjust_address_nv (x, GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), adjust);
2291 /* Set all of the memory attributes as appropriate for a spill. */
2292 set_mem_attrs_for_spill (x);
2294 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2295 reg_equiv_memory_loc (i) = x;
2299 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs used by
2300 pseudo-reg number REGNO, accessed in MODE. */
2302 static void
2303 mark_home_live_1 (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
2305 int i, lim;
2307 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2308 if (i < 0)
2309 return;
2310 lim = end_hard_regno (mode, i);
2311 while (i < lim)
2312 df_set_regs_ever_live (i++, true);
2315 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2316 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2318 void
2319 mark_home_live (int regno)
2321 if (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0)
2322 mark_home_live_1 (regno, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
2325 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2327 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2329 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2331 INITIAL_P is nonzero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2332 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2333 current offset. */
2335 static void
2336 set_label_offsets (rtx x, rtx insn, int initial_p)
2338 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2339 rtx tem;
2340 unsigned int i;
2341 struct elim_table *p;
2343 switch (code)
2345 case LABEL_REF:
2346 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2347 return;
2349 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2351 /* ... fall through ... */
2353 case CODE_LABEL:
2354 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2355 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2356 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2357 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2358 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2359 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2361 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num])
2363 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2364 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2365 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2366 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2367 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num] = 1;
2370 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2371 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2372 that label. */
2374 else if (x == insn
2375 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2376 && BARRIER_P (tem))
2377 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2378 else
2379 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2380 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2381 where the offsets disagree. */
2383 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2384 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2385 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2386 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2387 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2389 return;
2391 case JUMP_TABLE_DATA:
2392 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2393 return;
2395 case JUMP_INSN:
2396 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2398 /* ... fall through ... */
2400 case INSN:
2401 case CALL_INSN:
2402 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL_OPERAND notes can be branched
2403 to indirectly and hence must have all eliminations at their
2404 initial offsets. */
2405 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2406 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL_OPERAND)
2407 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2408 return;
2410 case PARALLEL:
2411 case ADDR_VEC:
2412 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2413 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2414 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2415 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2417 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2418 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2419 insn, initial_p);
2420 return;
2422 case SET:
2423 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2424 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2425 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2426 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2427 call ourselves recursively.
2429 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2430 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2431 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2432 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2433 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2435 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2436 return;
2438 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2440 case PC:
2441 case RETURN:
2442 return;
2444 case LABEL_REF:
2445 set_label_offsets (SET_SRC (x), insn, initial_p);
2446 return;
2448 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2449 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2450 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2451 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2452 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2453 break;
2455 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2456 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2457 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2458 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2459 break;
2460 return;
2462 default:
2463 break;
2466 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2467 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2468 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2469 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2470 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2471 break;
2473 default:
2474 break;
2478 /* Called through for_each_rtx, this function examines every reg that occurs
2479 in PX and adjusts the costs for its elimination which are gathered by IRA.
2480 DATA is the insn in which PX occurs. We do not recurse into MEM
2481 expressions. */
2483 static int
2484 note_reg_elim_costly (rtx *px, void *data)
2486 rtx insn = (rtx)data;
2487 rtx x = *px;
2489 if (MEM_P (x))
2490 return -1;
2492 if (REG_P (x)
2493 && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2494 && reg_equiv_init (REGNO (x))
2495 && reg_equiv_invariant (REGNO (x)))
2497 rtx t = reg_equiv_invariant (REGNO (x));
2498 rtx new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (t, Pmode, insn, true, true);
2499 int cost = set_src_cost (new_rtx, optimize_bb_for_speed_p (elim_bb));
2500 int freq = REG_FREQ_FROM_BB (elim_bb);
2502 if (cost != 0)
2503 ira_adjust_equiv_reg_cost (REGNO (x), -cost * freq);
2505 return 0;
2508 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2509 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2511 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2512 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2513 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2514 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2515 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2517 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2518 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is nonzero, write a
2519 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2520 the REG is being modified.
2522 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2523 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2524 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2525 is outside of MEMs.
2527 If FOR_COSTS is true, we are being called before reload in order to
2528 estimate the costs of keeping registers with an equivalence unallocated.
2530 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2531 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2532 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2533 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2534 the proper thing. */
2536 static rtx
2537 eliminate_regs_1 (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn,
2538 bool may_use_invariant, bool for_costs)
2540 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2541 struct elim_table *ep;
2542 int regno;
2543 rtx new_rtx;
2544 int i, j;
2545 const char *fmt;
2546 int copied = 0;
2548 if (! current_function_decl)
2549 return x;
2551 switch (code)
2553 CASE_CONST_ANY:
2554 case CONST:
2555 case SYMBOL_REF:
2556 case CODE_LABEL:
2557 case PC:
2558 case CC0:
2559 case ASM_INPUT:
2560 case ADDR_VEC:
2561 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2562 case RETURN:
2563 return x;
2565 case REG:
2566 regno = REGNO (x);
2568 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2569 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2570 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2572 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2573 ep++)
2574 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2575 return plus_constant (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2578 else if (reg_renumber && reg_renumber[regno] < 0
2579 && reg_equivs
2580 && reg_equiv_invariant (regno))
2582 if (may_use_invariant || (insn && DEBUG_INSN_P (insn)))
2583 return eliminate_regs_1 (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_invariant (regno)),
2584 mem_mode, insn, true, for_costs);
2585 /* There exists at least one use of REGNO that cannot be
2586 eliminated. Prevent the defining insn from being deleted. */
2587 reg_equiv_init (regno) = NULL_RTX;
2588 if (!for_costs)
2589 alter_reg (regno, -1, true);
2591 return x;
2593 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2594 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2595 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2597 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2598 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2600 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2601 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (IA-32,
2602 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2603 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2605 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2606 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2607 case PLUS:
2608 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2609 the sum. */
2610 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2611 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2612 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2614 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2615 ep++)
2616 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2618 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2619 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2620 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2621 to do so at other times because that would change the
2622 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2623 We special-case the commonest situation in
2624 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2625 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2626 if (mem_mode != 0 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
2627 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2628 return ep->to_rtx;
2629 else
2630 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2631 plus_constant (Pmode, XEXP (x, 1),
2632 ep->previous_offset));
2635 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2636 operand is a constant. */
2637 return x;
2640 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2641 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2642 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2644 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2645 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2646 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2647 operand of a load-address insn. */
2650 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true,
2651 for_costs);
2652 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2653 for_costs);
2655 if (reg_renumber && (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1)))
2657 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2658 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2659 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2660 be in the position of any operand. */
2661 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && REG_P (new1)
2662 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2663 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2664 && reg_equivs
2665 && reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (new1)) != 0)
2666 new1 = reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (new1));
2667 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && REG_P (new0)
2668 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2669 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2670 && reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (new0)) != 0)
2671 new0 = reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (new0));
2673 new_rtx = form_sum (GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2675 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2676 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2677 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2678 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new_rtx) != PLUS)
2679 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, const0_rtx);
2680 else
2681 return new_rtx;
2684 return x;
2686 case MULT:
2687 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2688 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2689 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2690 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2691 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2692 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2693 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2694 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2695 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2696 ep++)
2697 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2699 if (! mem_mode
2700 /* Refs inside notes or in DEBUG_INSNs don't count for
2701 this purpose. */
2702 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2703 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST
2704 || DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))))
2705 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2707 return
2708 plus_constant (Pmode,
2709 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2710 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2713 /* ... fall through ... */
2715 case CALL:
2716 case COMPARE:
2717 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2718 case MINUS:
2719 case DIV: case UDIV:
2720 case MOD: case UMOD:
2721 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2722 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2723 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2724 case NE: case EQ:
2725 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2726 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2728 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false,
2729 for_costs);
2730 rtx new1 = XEXP (x, 1)
2731 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, false,
2732 for_costs) : 0;
2734 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2735 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2737 return x;
2739 case EXPR_LIST:
2740 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2741 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2743 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true,
2744 for_costs);
2745 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2747 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2748 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2749 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2750 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_DEAD)
2751 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2752 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2753 for_costs)
2754 : NULL_RTX);
2756 x = alloc_reg_note (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new_rtx, XEXP (x, 1));
2760 /* ... fall through ... */
2762 case INSN_LIST:
2763 case INT_LIST:
2764 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2765 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2766 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2767 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2769 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true,
2770 for_costs);
2771 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 1))
2772 return
2773 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx);
2775 return x;
2777 case PRE_INC:
2778 case POST_INC:
2779 case PRE_DEC:
2780 case POST_DEC:
2781 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2782 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2783 happen. */
2784 return x;
2786 case PRE_MODIFY:
2787 case POST_MODIFY:
2788 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2789 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2790 happen. The only remaining case we need to consider here is
2791 that the increment value may be an eliminable register. */
2792 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2793 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0) == XEXP (x, 0))
2795 rtx new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1), mem_mode,
2796 insn, true, for_costs);
2798 if (new_rtx != XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1))
2799 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
2800 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x),
2801 XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx));
2803 return x;
2805 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2806 case NEG: case NOT:
2807 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2808 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2809 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2810 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2811 case ABS:
2812 case SQRT:
2813 case FFS:
2814 case CLZ:
2815 case CTZ:
2816 case POPCOUNT:
2817 case PARITY:
2818 case BSWAP:
2819 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false,
2820 for_costs);
2821 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2822 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2823 return x;
2825 case SUBREG:
2826 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2827 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2828 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2829 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2830 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reload
2831 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2832 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2833 && !paradoxical_subreg_p (x)
2834 && reg_equivs
2835 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))) != 0)
2837 new_rtx = SUBREG_REG (x);
2839 else
2840 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn, false, for_costs);
2842 if (new_rtx != SUBREG_REG (x))
2844 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2845 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new_rtx));
2847 if (MEM_P (new_rtx)
2848 && ((x_size < new_size
2849 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2850 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2851 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2852 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2853 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2854 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2855 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2856 subreg so that push_reload can see it. */
2857 && ! ((x_size - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2858 == (new_size -1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2859 #endif
2861 || x_size == new_size)
2863 return adjust_address_nv (new_rtx, GET_MODE (x), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2864 else
2865 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2868 return x;
2870 case MEM:
2871 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2872 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2873 case more efficiently. */
2875 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), insn, true,
2876 for_costs);
2877 if (for_costs
2878 && memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
2879 && !memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx))
2880 for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), note_reg_elim_costly, insn);
2882 return replace_equiv_address_nv (x, new_rtx);
2884 case USE:
2885 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2886 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), VOIDmode, insn, false,
2887 for_costs);
2888 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2889 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2890 return x;
2892 case CLOBBER:
2893 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2894 gcc_assert (insn && DEBUG_INSN_P (insn));
2895 break;
2897 case SET:
2898 gcc_unreachable ();
2900 default:
2901 break;
2904 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2905 copy of the rtx. */
2906 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2907 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2909 if (*fmt == 'e')
2911 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn, false,
2912 for_costs);
2913 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2915 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2916 copied = 1;
2918 XEXP (x, i) = new_rtx;
2920 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2922 int copied_vec = 0;
2923 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2925 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn, false,
2926 for_costs);
2927 if (new_rtx != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2929 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2930 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2931 if (! copied)
2933 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2934 copied = 1;
2936 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2937 copied_vec = 1;
2939 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new_rtx;
2944 return x;
2948 eliminate_regs (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn)
2950 return eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, insn, false, false);
2953 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2954 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2955 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2957 static void
2958 elimination_effects (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode)
2960 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2961 struct elim_table *ep;
2962 int regno;
2963 int i, j;
2964 const char *fmt;
2966 switch (code)
2968 CASE_CONST_ANY:
2969 case CONST:
2970 case SYMBOL_REF:
2971 case CODE_LABEL:
2972 case PC:
2973 case CC0:
2974 case ASM_INPUT:
2975 case ADDR_VEC:
2976 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2977 case RETURN:
2978 return;
2980 case REG:
2981 regno = REGNO (x);
2983 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2984 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2985 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2987 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2988 ep++)
2989 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2991 if (! mem_mode)
2992 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2993 return;
2997 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0
2998 && reg_equivs
2999 && reg_equiv_constant (regno)
3000 && ! function_invariant_p (reg_equiv_constant (regno)))
3001 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant (regno), mem_mode);
3002 return;
3004 case PRE_INC:
3005 case POST_INC:
3006 case PRE_DEC:
3007 case POST_DEC:
3008 case POST_MODIFY:
3009 case PRE_MODIFY:
3010 /* If we modify the source of an elimination rule, disable it. */
3011 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3012 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3013 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3015 /* If we modify the target of an elimination rule by adding a constant,
3016 update its offset. If we modify the target in any other way, we'll
3017 have to disable the rule as well. */
3018 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3019 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3021 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
3023 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
3024 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3025 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
3026 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
3027 #endif
3028 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3029 ep->offset += size;
3030 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
3031 ep->offset -= size;
3032 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3034 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
3035 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
3036 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
3037 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
3038 else
3039 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3043 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
3044 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
3045 break;
3047 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
3048 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
3049 case NEG: case NOT:
3050 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
3051 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
3052 case FLOAT: case FIX:
3053 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
3054 case ABS:
3055 case SQRT:
3056 case FFS:
3057 case CLZ:
3058 case CTZ:
3059 case POPCOUNT:
3060 case PARITY:
3061 case BSWAP:
3062 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3063 return;
3065 case SUBREG:
3066 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
3067 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
3068 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
3069 && reg_equivs
3070 && reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))) != 0)
3071 return;
3073 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
3074 return;
3076 case USE:
3077 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
3078 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
3079 know how this register is used. */
3080 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3081 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3082 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3084 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3085 return;
3087 case CLOBBER:
3088 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
3089 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
3090 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
3091 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3092 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3093 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3095 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3096 return;
3098 case SET:
3099 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3100 if (REG_P (SET_DEST (x)))
3102 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
3103 elimination.
3105 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
3106 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
3107 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
3108 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
3109 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
3110 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
3111 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
3113 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3114 ep++)
3115 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
3116 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3118 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
3119 this elimination can't be done. */
3120 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
3122 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
3123 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
3124 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
3125 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
3126 else
3127 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3131 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), VOIDmode);
3132 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), VOIDmode);
3133 return;
3135 case MEM:
3136 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
3137 recursive call. */
3138 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
3139 return;
3141 default:
3142 break;
3145 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3146 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3148 if (*fmt == 'e')
3149 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
3150 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3151 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3152 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
3156 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
3157 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
3158 eliminable. */
3160 static void
3161 check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx x)
3163 const char *fmt;
3164 int i;
3165 enum rtx_code code;
3167 if (x == 0)
3168 return;
3170 code = GET_CODE (x);
3172 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3174 struct elim_table *ep;
3176 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3177 if (ep->from_rtx == x)
3178 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3179 return;
3182 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3183 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3185 if (*fmt == 'e')
3186 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
3187 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3189 int j;
3190 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3191 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3196 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
3198 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
3199 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
3201 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
3203 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
3204 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
3205 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
3206 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
3207 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
3209 static int
3210 eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx insn, int replace)
3212 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
3213 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
3214 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
3215 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
3216 rtx new_body;
3217 int val = 0;
3218 int i;
3219 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3220 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3221 struct elim_table *ep;
3222 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
3224 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
3226 gcc_assert (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn)
3227 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3228 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
3229 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT);
3230 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3231 INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn)
3232 = eliminate_regs (INSN_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (insn), VOIDmode, insn);
3233 return 0;
3236 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3237 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3239 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
3240 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3241 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
3243 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3244 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
3245 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
3246 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
3247 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
3248 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
3249 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3250 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3252 rtx base = SET_SRC (old_set);
3253 rtx base_insn = insn;
3254 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
3256 while (base != ep->to_rtx)
3258 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
3260 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS
3261 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (base, 1)))
3263 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
3264 base = XEXP (base, 0);
3266 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (base_insn)) != 0
3267 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
3268 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), base))
3270 base = SET_SRC (prev_set);
3271 base_insn = prev_insn;
3273 else
3274 break;
3277 if (base == ep->to_rtx)
3279 rtx src = plus_constant (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
3280 offset - ep->offset);
3282 new_body = old_body;
3283 if (! replace)
3285 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3286 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3287 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3289 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3290 old_set = single_set (insn);
3292 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
3293 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
3294 the same and let reload fit it up. */
3295 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
3296 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
3297 ep->to_rtx, 1);
3298 if (! apply_change_group ())
3300 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
3301 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
3304 val = 1;
3305 goto done;
3308 #endif
3310 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3311 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3312 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3314 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3315 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3316 if (replace)
3318 delete_dead_insn (insn);
3319 return 1;
3321 val = 1;
3322 goto done;
3326 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3327 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3328 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3329 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3330 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3332 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3333 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3334 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3335 if (plus_src
3336 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3337 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3338 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3339 || plus_src)
3341 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3342 (plus (...) CST). */
3343 rtx links;
3344 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3346 if ((REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3347 || REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUIV)
3348 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3349 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)))
3351 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3352 break;
3357 /* Check that the first operand of the PLUS is a hard reg or
3358 the lowpart subreg of one. */
3359 if (plus_cst_src)
3361 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3362 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (reg))
3363 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3365 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3366 plus_cst_src = 0;
3369 if (plus_cst_src)
3371 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3372 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 1));
3374 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
3375 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3377 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3378 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
3380 rtx to_rtx = ep->to_rtx;
3381 offset += ep->offset;
3382 offset = trunc_int_for_mode (offset, GET_MODE (plus_cst_src));
3384 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)) == SUBREG)
3385 to_rtx = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)),
3386 to_rtx);
3387 /* If we have a nonzero offset, and the source is already
3388 a simple REG, the following transformation would
3389 increase the cost of the insn by replacing a simple REG
3390 with (plus (reg sp) CST). So try only when we already
3391 had a PLUS before. */
3392 if (offset == 0 || plus_src)
3394 rtx new_src = plus_constant (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
3395 to_rtx, offset);
3397 new_body = old_body;
3398 if (! replace)
3400 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3401 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3402 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3404 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3405 old_set = single_set (insn);
3407 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we make the
3408 change. If not, try to replace the whole pattern with
3409 a simple set (this may help if the original insn was a
3410 PARALLEL that was only recognized as single_set due to
3411 REG_UNUSED notes). If this isn't valid either, keep
3412 the INSN_CODE the same and let reload fix it up. */
3413 if (!validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), new_src, 0))
3415 rtx new_pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
3416 SET_DEST (old_set), new_src);
3418 if (!validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn), new_pat, 0))
3419 SET_SRC (old_set) = new_src;
3422 else
3423 break;
3425 val = 1;
3426 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3427 to the end. */
3428 goto done;
3432 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3433 elimination_effects (old_body, VOIDmode);
3435 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3436 can be handled by reload. */
3437 extract_insn (insn);
3438 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3440 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3441 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3443 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3444 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3446 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3448 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3449 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3450 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3452 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3453 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3454 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3455 eliminate this reg. */
3456 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3457 ep++)
3458 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3459 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3462 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3463 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3464 is_set_src = false;
3465 if (old_set
3466 && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3467 is_set_src = true;
3468 in_plus = false;
3469 if (plus_src
3470 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3471 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3472 in_plus = true;
3474 substed_operand[i]
3475 = eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], VOIDmode,
3476 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX,
3477 is_set_src || in_plus, false);
3478 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3479 val = 1;
3480 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3481 this point. */
3482 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3484 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3485 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3486 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3487 && REG_P (orig_operand[i])
3488 && MEM_P (substed_operand[i])
3489 && replace)
3490 emit_insn_after (gen_clobber (orig_operand[i]), insn);
3494 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3495 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3496 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3498 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3499 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3501 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3502 array. */
3503 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3504 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3505 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3506 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3508 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3509 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3510 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3511 common case.
3512 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3513 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3514 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3515 again. */
3517 if (val)
3519 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3520 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3521 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3522 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3523 new_body = old_body;
3524 if (! replace)
3526 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3527 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3528 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3530 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3532 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3533 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3534 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3535 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3536 hurt in this rare case. */
3537 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3538 thing always? */
3539 if (! insn_is_asm
3540 && old_set != 0
3541 && ((REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3542 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3543 || !REG_P (SET_SRC (new_body))))
3544 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3545 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3546 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3547 || (old_set != 0
3548 && ((MEM_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3549 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3550 || (MEM_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3551 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3552 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3553 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3555 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3556 if (new_icode >= 0)
3557 INSN_CODE (insn) = new_icode;
3561 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3562 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3563 a modified insn below. */
3564 if (! replace)
3566 /* Restore the old body. */
3567 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3568 /* Restoring a top-level match_parallel would clobber the new_body
3569 we installed in the insn. */
3570 if (recog_data.operand_loc[i] != &PATTERN (insn))
3571 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3572 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3573 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3576 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3577 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3578 elimination_effects.
3580 We also detect cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3581 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3582 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3583 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3584 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3585 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3587 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3589 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3591 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3592 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3594 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3596 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3597 val = 1;
3600 done:
3601 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3602 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3603 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3604 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3605 the pre-passes. */
3606 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3607 REG_NOTES (insn)
3608 = eliminate_regs_1 (REG_NOTES (insn), VOIDmode, REG_NOTES (insn), true,
3609 false);
3611 return val;
3614 /* Like eliminate_regs_in_insn, but only estimate costs for the use of the
3615 register allocator. INSN is the instruction we need to examine, we perform
3616 eliminations in its operands and record cases where eliminating a reg with
3617 an invariant equivalence would add extra cost. */
3619 static void
3620 elimination_costs_in_insn (rtx insn)
3622 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
3623 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
3624 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
3625 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
3626 int i;
3627 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3628 rtx orig_dup[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3629 struct elim_table *ep;
3630 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
3631 bool sets_reg_p;
3633 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
3635 gcc_assert (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn)
3636 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3637 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
3638 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT);
3639 return;
3642 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3643 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3645 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
3646 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3647 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
3648 return;
3651 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3652 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3653 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3654 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3655 sets_reg_p = false;
3656 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3658 sets_reg_p = true;
3659 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3660 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3661 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3662 if (plus_src
3663 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3664 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3665 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3666 || plus_src)
3668 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3669 (plus (...) CST). */
3670 rtx links;
3671 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3673 if ((REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3674 || REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUIV)
3675 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3676 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)))
3678 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3679 break;
3685 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3686 elimination_effects (old_body, VOIDmode);
3688 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3689 can be handled by reload. */
3690 extract_insn (insn);
3691 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3692 orig_dup[i] = *recog_data.dup_loc[i];
3694 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3696 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3698 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3699 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3701 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3703 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3704 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3705 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3707 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3708 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3709 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3710 eliminate this reg. */
3711 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3712 ep++)
3713 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3714 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3717 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3718 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3719 is_set_src = false;
3720 if (old_set && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3721 is_set_src = true;
3722 if (is_set_src && !sets_reg_p)
3723 note_reg_elim_costly (&SET_SRC (old_set), insn);
3724 in_plus = false;
3725 if (plus_src && sets_reg_p
3726 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3727 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3728 in_plus = true;
3730 eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], VOIDmode,
3731 NULL_RTX,
3732 is_set_src || in_plus, true);
3733 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3734 this point. */
3735 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3739 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3740 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3741 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3743 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3744 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3746 /* Restore the old body. */
3747 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3748 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3749 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3750 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_dup[i];
3752 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3753 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3754 elimination_effects. */
3756 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3758 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3759 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3761 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3764 return;
3767 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3768 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3770 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3771 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3773 static void
3774 update_eliminable_offsets (void)
3776 struct elim_table *ep;
3778 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3779 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3781 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3782 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3783 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3787 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3788 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3789 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3791 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3792 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3793 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3794 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3795 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3796 prevent this elimination.
3798 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3799 the insns of the function. */
3801 static void
3802 mark_not_eliminable (rtx dest, const_rtx x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3804 unsigned int i;
3806 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3807 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3808 case. */
3809 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3810 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3812 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3813 return;
3815 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3816 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3817 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3818 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3819 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3820 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1))))
3822 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3823 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3824 num_eliminable--;
3828 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3829 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3830 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3831 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3833 static bool
3834 verify_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3836 HOST_WIDE_INT t;
3838 if (!num_eliminable)
3839 return true;
3841 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3843 struct elim_table *ep;
3845 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3847 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3848 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3849 return false;
3852 #else
3853 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3854 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3855 return false;
3856 #endif
3858 return true;
3861 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3863 static void
3864 set_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3866 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3868 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3869 for (; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3871 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3872 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3874 #else
3875 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3876 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3877 #endif
3879 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3882 /* Subroutine of set_initial_label_offsets called via for_each_eh_label. */
3884 static void
3885 set_initial_eh_label_offset (rtx label)
3887 set_label_offsets (label, NULL_RTX, 1);
3890 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3891 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3892 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3893 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3894 at its initial offset.
3895 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3897 static void
3898 set_initial_label_offsets (void)
3900 rtx x;
3901 memset (offsets_known_at, 0, num_labels);
3903 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3904 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3905 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3907 for (x = nonlocal_goto_handler_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3908 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3909 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3911 for_each_eh_label (set_initial_eh_label_offset);
3914 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3915 by INSN. */
3917 static void
3918 set_offsets_for_label (rtx insn)
3920 unsigned int i;
3921 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3922 struct elim_table *ep;
3924 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3925 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3927 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset
3928 = offsets_at[label_nr - first_label_num][i];
3929 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3930 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3934 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3935 For example, on the SPARC, whether or not the frame pointer can
3936 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3937 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3938 since they can't have changed. */
3940 static void
3941 update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *pset)
3943 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3944 struct elim_table *ep;
3946 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3947 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3948 && targetm.frame_pointer_required ())
3949 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3950 || ! targetm.can_eliminate (ep->from, ep->to)
3951 #endif
3953 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3955 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3956 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3957 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3958 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3959 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3960 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3962 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3964 struct elim_table *op;
3965 int new_to = -1;
3967 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3969 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3970 new one. */
3971 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3972 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3973 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3975 new_to = op->to;
3976 break;
3979 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3980 disable it. */
3981 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3982 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3983 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3984 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3988 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3989 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3990 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3991 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3992 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3994 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3995 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3997 if (ep->can_eliminate
3998 && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3999 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
4000 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
4001 || ! crtl->stack_realign_needed))
4002 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
4004 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
4006 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
4007 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
4008 num_eliminable--;
4012 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
4013 the hard frame pointer. */
4014 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
4015 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
4018 /* Call update_eliminables an spill any registers we can't eliminate anymore.
4019 Return true iff a register was spilled. */
4021 static bool
4022 update_eliminables_and_spill (void)
4024 int i;
4025 bool did_spill = false;
4026 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
4027 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
4028 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
4029 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, to_spill);
4031 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4032 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
4034 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
4035 did_spill = true;
4037 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
4038 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but now can
4039 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
4041 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
4042 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
4043 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
4044 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
4045 performed. */
4047 return did_spill;
4050 /* Return true if X is used as the target register of an elimination. */
4052 bool
4053 elimination_target_reg_p (rtx x)
4055 struct elim_table *ep;
4057 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
4058 if (ep->to_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
4059 return true;
4061 return false;
4064 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate.
4065 Pre-condition: global flag frame_pointer_needed has been set before
4066 calling this function. */
4068 static void
4069 init_elim_table (void)
4071 struct elim_table *ep;
4072 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
4073 const struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
4074 #endif
4076 if (!reg_eliminate)
4077 reg_eliminate = XCNEWVEC (struct elim_table, NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
4079 num_eliminable = 0;
4081 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
4082 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
4083 ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
4085 ep->from = ep1->from;
4086 ep->to = ep1->to;
4087 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
4088 = (targetm.can_eliminate (ep->from, ep->to)
4089 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
4090 && frame_pointer_needed
4091 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
4092 || ! stack_realign_fp)));
4094 #else
4095 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
4096 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
4097 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
4098 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
4099 #endif
4101 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
4102 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx_REG will cause, e.g.,
4103 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
4104 We depend on this. */
4105 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
4107 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
4108 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
4109 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
4113 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
4114 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
4115 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
4116 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
4118 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
4119 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
4120 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
4121 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
4123 static void
4124 init_eliminable_invariants (rtx first, bool do_subregs)
4126 int i;
4127 rtx insn;
4129 grow_reg_equivs ();
4130 if (do_subregs)
4131 reg_max_ref_width = XCNEWVEC (unsigned int, max_regno);
4132 else
4133 reg_max_ref_width = NULL;
4135 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
4137 first_label_num = get_first_label_num ();
4138 num_labels = max_label_num () - first_label_num;
4140 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
4141 offsets_known_at = XNEWVEC (char, num_labels);
4142 offsets_at = (HOST_WIDE_INT (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
4144 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent
4145 to. If DO_SUBREGS is true, also find all paradoxical subregs and
4146 find largest such for each pseudo. FIRST is the head of the insn
4147 list. */
4149 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
4151 rtx set = single_set (insn);
4153 /* We may introduce USEs that we want to remove at the end, so
4154 we'll mark them with QImode. Make sure there are no
4155 previously-marked insns left by say regmove. */
4156 if (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
4157 && GET_MODE (insn) != VOIDmode)
4158 PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
4160 if (do_subregs && NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
4161 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
4163 if (set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set)))
4165 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
4166 rtx x;
4168 if (! note)
4169 continue;
4171 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
4172 x = XEXP (note, 0);
4174 if (i <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
4175 continue;
4177 /* If flag_pic and we have constant, verify it's legitimate. */
4178 if (!CONSTANT_P (x)
4179 || !flag_pic || LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x))
4181 /* It can happen that a REG_EQUIV note contains a MEM
4182 that is not a legitimate memory operand. As later
4183 stages of reload assume that all addresses found
4184 in the reg_equiv_* arrays were originally legitimate,
4185 we ignore such REG_EQUIV notes. */
4186 if (memory_operand (x, VOIDmode))
4188 /* Always unshare the equivalence, so we can
4189 substitute into this insn without touching the
4190 equivalence. */
4191 reg_equiv_memory_loc (i) = copy_rtx (x);
4193 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
4195 enum machine_mode mode;
4197 mode = GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set));
4198 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
4200 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
4201 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
4202 reg_equiv_invariant (i) = copy_rtx (x);
4203 num_eliminable_invariants++;
4205 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
4207 reg_equiv_invariant (i) = x;
4208 num_eliminable_invariants++;
4210 else if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4211 reg_equiv_constant (i) = x;
4212 else
4214 reg_equiv_memory_loc (i) = force_const_mem (mode, x);
4215 if (! reg_equiv_memory_loc (i))
4216 reg_equiv_init (i) = NULL_RTX;
4219 else
4221 reg_equiv_init (i) = NULL_RTX;
4222 continue;
4225 else
4226 reg_equiv_init (i) = NULL_RTX;
4230 if (dump_file)
4231 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
4232 if (reg_equiv_init (i))
4234 fprintf (dump_file, "init_insns for %u: ", i);
4235 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, reg_equiv_init (i), 20);
4236 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4240 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants.
4241 Free all data involved in tracking these. */
4243 static void
4244 free_reg_equiv (void)
4246 int i;
4248 free (offsets_known_at);
4249 free (offsets_at);
4250 offsets_at = 0;
4251 offsets_known_at = 0;
4253 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4254 if (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list (i))
4255 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&reg_equiv_alt_mem_list (i));
4256 vec_free (reg_equivs);
4259 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
4261 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
4262 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
4263 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
4264 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
4265 hard reg to produce another spill register.
4267 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
4269 static void
4270 spill_hard_reg (unsigned int regno, int cant_eliminate)
4272 int i;
4274 if (cant_eliminate)
4276 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
4277 df_set_regs_ever_live (regno, true);
4280 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
4281 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
4283 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
4284 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
4285 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
4286 && end_hard_regno (PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i), reg_renumber[i]) > regno)
4287 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
4290 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
4291 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
4292 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
4293 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
4295 static int
4296 finish_spills (int global)
4298 struct insn_chain *chain;
4299 int something_changed = 0;
4300 unsigned i;
4301 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4303 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
4304 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
4305 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
4306 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
4307 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
4309 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
4310 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
4311 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
4312 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
4313 but must be saved by the prologue. */
4315 n_spills = 0;
4316 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4317 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
4319 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
4320 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
4321 if (num_eliminable && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (i))
4322 something_changed = 1;
4323 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
4325 else
4326 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
4328 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4329 if (! ira_conflicts_p || reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
4331 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to
4332 in pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the
4333 same hard reg in a later pass. */
4334 gcc_assert (reg_renumber[i] >= 0);
4336 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
4337 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
4338 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
4339 if (ira_conflicts_p)
4340 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
4341 ira_mark_allocation_change (i);
4342 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
4343 something_changed = 1;
4346 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
4347 if (global && ira_conflicts_p)
4349 unsigned int n;
4351 memset (pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
4352 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
4353 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
4354 insn. */
4355 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
4357 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
4358 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4360 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
4361 chain->used_spill_regs);
4363 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
4364 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
4366 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
4367 chain->used_spill_regs);
4371 /* Retry allocating the pseudos spilled in IRA and the
4372 reload. For each reg, merge the various reg sets that
4373 indicate which hard regs can't be used, and call
4374 ira_reassign_pseudos. */
4375 for (n = 0, i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned) max_regno; i++)
4376 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
4378 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
4379 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
4380 else
4381 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
4383 if (ira_reassign_pseudos (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n,
4384 bad_spill_regs_global,
4385 pseudo_forbidden_regs, pseudo_previous_regs,
4386 &spilled_pseudos))
4387 something_changed = 1;
4389 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
4390 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
4391 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
4392 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
4394 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
4395 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
4397 if (! ira_conflicts_p)
4399 /* Don't do it for IRA because IRA and the reload still can
4400 assign hard registers to the spilled pseudos on next
4401 reload iterations. */
4402 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
4403 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
4405 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
4406 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
4407 if (chain->need_reload)
4409 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4410 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
4411 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
4413 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4414 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
4415 /* Value of chain->used_spill_regs from previous iteration
4416 may be not included in the value calculated here because
4417 of possible removing caller-saves insns (see function
4418 delete_caller_save_insns. */
4419 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
4420 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
4424 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
4425 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
4426 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
4428 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
4429 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
4430 continue;
4432 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos, i);
4434 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i], false);
4435 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
4436 if (dump_file)
4438 if (regno == -1)
4439 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
4440 else
4441 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
4442 i, reg_renumber[i]);
4446 return something_changed;
4449 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width. */
4451 static void
4452 scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx x)
4454 int i;
4455 const char *fmt;
4456 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
4458 switch (code)
4460 case REG:
4461 case CONST:
4462 case SYMBOL_REF:
4463 case LABEL_REF:
4464 CASE_CONST_ANY:
4465 case CC0:
4466 case PC:
4467 case USE:
4468 case CLOBBER:
4469 return;
4471 case SUBREG:
4472 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4473 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
4474 > reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]))
4476 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
4477 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
4478 mark_home_live_1 (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)), GET_MODE (x));
4480 return;
4482 default:
4483 break;
4486 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
4487 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4489 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
4490 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
4491 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
4493 int j;
4494 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
4495 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
4500 /* *OP_PTR and *OTHER_PTR are two operands to a conceptual reload.
4501 If *OP_PTR is a paradoxical subreg, try to remove that subreg
4502 and apply the corresponding narrowing subreg to *OTHER_PTR.
4503 Return true if the operands were changed, false otherwise. */
4505 static bool
4506 strip_paradoxical_subreg (rtx *op_ptr, rtx *other_ptr)
4508 rtx op, inner, other, tem;
4510 op = *op_ptr;
4511 if (!paradoxical_subreg_p (op))
4512 return false;
4513 inner = SUBREG_REG (op);
4515 other = *other_ptr;
4516 tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (inner), other);
4517 if (!tem)
4518 return false;
4520 /* If the lowpart operation turned a hard register into a subreg,
4521 rather than simplifying it to another hard register, then the
4522 mode change cannot be properly represented. For example, OTHER
4523 might be valid in its current mode, but not in the new one. */
4524 if (GET_CODE (tem) == SUBREG
4525 && REG_P (other)
4526 && HARD_REGISTER_P (other))
4527 return false;
4529 *op_ptr = inner;
4530 *other_ptr = tem;
4531 return true;
4534 /* A subroutine of reload_as_needed. If INSN has a REG_EH_REGION note,
4535 examine all of the reload insns between PREV and NEXT exclusive, and
4536 annotate all that may trap. */
4538 static void
4539 fixup_eh_region_note (rtx insn, rtx prev, rtx next)
4541 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
4542 if (note == NULL)
4543 return;
4544 if (!insn_could_throw_p (insn))
4545 remove_note (insn, note);
4546 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (note, NEXT_INSN (prev), next);
4549 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
4550 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
4551 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
4553 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
4554 which registers are already available in reload registers.
4555 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
4556 as the insns are scanned. */
4558 static void
4559 reload_as_needed (int live_known)
4561 struct insn_chain *chain;
4562 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
4563 int i;
4564 #endif
4565 rtx x, marker;
4567 memset (spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
4568 memset (spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
4569 reg_last_reload_reg = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4570 INIT_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4571 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4572 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4574 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
4576 /* Generate a marker insn that we will move around. */
4577 marker = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
4578 unlink_insn_chain (marker, marker);
4580 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
4582 rtx prev = 0;
4583 rtx insn = chain->insn;
4584 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4585 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4586 rtx old_prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4587 #endif
4589 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
4590 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
4591 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4592 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
4594 else if (INSN_P (insn))
4596 regset_head regs_to_forget;
4597 INIT_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4598 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), forget_old_reloads_1, &regs_to_forget);
4600 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
4601 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
4603 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
4604 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
4605 && MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))
4606 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
4607 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
4608 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
4609 NULL_RTX);
4611 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
4612 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
4613 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
4615 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
4616 if (NOTE_P (insn))
4618 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4619 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4620 continue;
4624 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
4625 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
4626 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
4627 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
4628 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
4629 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
4631 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
4632 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
4633 n_reloads = 0;
4634 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
4635 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
4636 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
4637 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
4638 else
4640 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4641 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
4643 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
4644 spill_reg_order);
4647 if (n_reloads > 0)
4649 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4650 rtx p;
4652 /* ??? PREV can get deleted by reload inheritance.
4653 Work around this by emitting a marker note. */
4654 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4655 reorder_insns_nobb (marker, marker, prev);
4657 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
4658 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
4659 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
4660 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
4661 choose_reload_regs (chain);
4663 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
4664 their reload regs. */
4665 emit_reload_insns (chain);
4667 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
4668 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
4669 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
4670 and that we moved the structure into). */
4671 subst_reloads (insn);
4673 prev = PREV_INSN (marker);
4674 unlink_insn_chain (marker, marker);
4676 /* Adjust the exception region notes for loads and stores. */
4677 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions && !CALL_P (insn))
4678 fixup_eh_region_note (insn, prev, next);
4680 /* Adjust the location of REG_ARGS_SIZE. */
4681 p = find_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, NULL_RTX);
4682 if (p)
4684 remove_note (insn, p);
4685 fixup_args_size_notes (prev, PREV_INSN (next),
4686 INTVAL (XEXP (p, 0)));
4689 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
4690 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
4691 and delete them. */
4692 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
4693 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
4694 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
4695 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) != USE
4696 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
4697 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
4699 error_for_asm (insn,
4700 "%<asm%> operand requires "
4701 "impossible reload");
4702 delete_insn (p);
4706 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
4707 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4709 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
4710 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
4711 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
4712 for this insn in order to be stored in
4713 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
4714 registers ARE still valid. */
4715 forget_marked_reloads (&regs_to_forget);
4716 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4718 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
4719 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
4720 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4721 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (x) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
4722 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
4724 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4725 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
4726 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
4727 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
4728 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
4729 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4731 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
4732 if (in_reg)
4734 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
4735 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
4736 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
4737 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
4738 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
4739 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
4740 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4741 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4742 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4743 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4744 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4745 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4746 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4749 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4750 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
4751 int n = 0;
4752 rtx p;
4754 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
4756 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
4757 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
4758 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
4759 break;
4760 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
4761 if (! n)
4762 continue;
4763 if (n == 1)
4765 rtx replace_reg
4766 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, mode, reload_reg);
4768 validate_replace_rtx_group (reload_reg,
4769 replace_reg, p);
4770 n = verify_changes (0);
4772 /* We must also verify that the constraints
4773 are met after the replacement. Make sure
4774 extract_insn is only called for an insn
4775 where the replacements were found to be
4776 valid so far. */
4777 if (n)
4779 extract_insn (p);
4780 n = constrain_operands (1);
4783 /* If the constraints were not met, then
4784 undo the replacement, else confirm it. */
4785 if (!n)
4786 cancel_changes (0);
4787 else
4788 confirm_change_group ();
4790 break;
4792 if (n == 1)
4794 add_reg_note (p, REG_INC, reload_reg);
4795 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4796 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4797 the reload for inheritance. */
4798 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4799 REGNO (reload_reg));
4800 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4801 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4803 else
4804 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
4805 NULL);
4807 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
4808 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4809 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4810 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4811 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4812 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4813 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4815 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4816 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
4817 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4818 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4820 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC
4821 || code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4823 int in_regno = REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0));
4825 if (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] != NULL_RTX)
4827 int in_hard_regno;
4828 bool forget_p = true;
4830 in_hard_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno]);
4831 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4832 in_hard_regno))
4834 for (x = old_prev ? NEXT_INSN (old_prev) : insn;
4835 x != old_next;
4836 x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4837 if (x == reg_reloaded_insn[in_hard_regno])
4839 forget_p = false;
4840 break;
4843 /* If for some reasons, we didn't set up
4844 reg_last_reload_reg in this insn,
4845 invalidate inheritance from previous
4846 insns for the incremented/decremented
4847 register. Such registers will be not in
4848 reg_has_output_reload. Invalidate it
4849 also if the corresponding element in
4850 reg_reloaded_insn is also
4851 invalidated. */
4852 if (forget_p)
4853 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0),
4854 NULL_RTX, NULL);
4859 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4860 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4861 hard registers. */
4862 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
4863 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
4865 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4866 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4867 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4868 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4869 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
4870 break;
4872 if (i == n_reloads)
4873 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
4875 #endif
4877 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4878 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4879 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4881 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4882 if it is a call-used reg, or if it contains a value that will
4883 be partially clobbered by the call. */
4884 else if (CALL_P (insn))
4886 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
4887 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4889 /* If this is a call to a setjmp-type function, we must not
4890 reuse any reload reg contents across the call; that will
4891 just be clobbered by other uses of the register in later
4892 code, before the longjmp. */
4893 if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_SETJMP, NULL_RTX))
4894 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4898 /* Clean up. */
4899 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
4900 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4903 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4904 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4905 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4907 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4908 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from.
4910 When DATA is non-NULL just mark the registers in regset
4911 to be forgotten later. */
4913 static void
4914 forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx x, const_rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4915 void *data)
4917 unsigned int regno;
4918 unsigned int nr;
4919 regset regs = (regset) data;
4921 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4922 subreg_regno_offset requires a hard reg. */
4923 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4925 /* We ignore the subreg offset when calculating the regno,
4926 because we are using the entire underlying hard register
4927 below. */
4928 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4931 if (!REG_P (x))
4932 return;
4934 regno = REGNO (x);
4936 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4937 nr = 1;
4938 else
4940 unsigned int i;
4942 nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)];
4943 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4944 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4945 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4946 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4947 if (!regs)
4948 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4949 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4950 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4951 if (n_reloads == 0
4952 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4954 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4955 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4959 if (regs)
4960 while (nr-- > 0)
4961 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (regs, regno + nr);
4962 else
4964 /* Since value of X has changed,
4965 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4967 while (nr-- > 0)
4968 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4969 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4970 if (n_reloads == 0
4971 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, regno + nr))
4972 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4976 /* Forget the reloads marked in regset by previous function. */
4977 static void
4978 forget_marked_reloads (regset regs)
4980 unsigned int reg;
4981 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4982 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (regs, 0, reg, rsi)
4984 if (reg < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4985 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4986 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4987 && (n_reloads == 0
4988 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, reg)))
4990 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reg);
4991 spill_reg_store[reg] = 0;
4993 if (n_reloads == 0
4994 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, reg))
4995 reg_last_reload_reg[reg] = 0;
4999 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
5000 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
5002 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
5003 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
5004 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
5005 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
5006 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
5007 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5008 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
5009 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5010 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
5011 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5012 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
5013 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5014 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
5015 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5016 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
5017 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
5018 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
5019 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
5020 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
5021 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
5022 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
5023 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
5024 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
5025 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
5027 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
5028 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
5030 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
5031 in the group. */
5032 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
5034 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
5035 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
5036 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
5038 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
5039 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
5040 actually used. */
5042 static void
5043 mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type,
5044 enum machine_mode mode)
5046 switch (type)
5048 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5049 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used, mode, regno);
5050 break;
5052 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5053 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], mode, regno);
5054 break;
5056 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5057 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], mode, regno);
5058 break;
5060 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5061 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], mode, regno);
5062 break;
5064 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5065 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], mode, regno);
5066 break;
5068 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5069 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, mode, regno);
5070 break;
5072 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5073 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, mode, regno);
5074 break;
5076 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5077 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, mode, regno);
5078 break;
5080 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5081 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], mode, regno);
5082 break;
5084 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5085 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], mode, regno);
5086 break;
5088 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5089 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_in_insn, mode, regno);
5090 break;
5093 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reload_reg_used_at_all, mode, regno);
5096 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
5098 static void
5099 clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum,
5100 enum reload_type type, enum machine_mode mode)
5102 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
5103 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
5104 int i;
5105 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
5106 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
5107 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
5108 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
5109 int check_opnum = 0;
5110 int check_any = 0;
5111 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
5113 switch (type)
5115 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5116 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
5117 break;
5119 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5120 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
5121 break;
5123 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5124 check_opnum = 1;
5125 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
5126 break;
5128 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5129 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
5130 break;
5132 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5133 check_opnum = 1;
5134 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
5135 break;
5137 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5138 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
5139 break;
5141 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5142 check_any = 1;
5143 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
5144 break;
5146 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5147 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
5148 check_any = 1;
5149 break;
5151 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5152 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
5153 break;
5155 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5156 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
5157 break;
5159 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5160 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
5161 break;
5162 default:
5163 gcc_unreachable ();
5165 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
5166 excluding the intervals of reload registers by them from the
5167 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
5168 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
5169 more than what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
5170 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
5171 be no reason to worry about it. */
5173 start_regno = regno;
5174 end_regno = regno + nregs;
5175 if (check_opnum || check_any)
5177 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5179 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
5180 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
5181 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
5183 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
5184 unsigned int conflict_end
5185 = end_hard_regno (rld[i].mode, conflict_start);
5187 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
5188 adjust the interval start. */
5189 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
5190 start_regno = conflict_end;
5191 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
5192 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
5193 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
5194 end_regno = conflict_start;
5199 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
5200 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
5203 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
5204 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
5206 static int
5207 reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
5209 int i;
5211 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
5212 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
5213 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
5214 return 0;
5216 switch (type)
5218 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5219 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
5220 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
5221 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5222 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
5223 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
5224 return 0;
5226 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5227 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5228 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5229 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5230 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5231 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
5232 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5233 return 0;
5235 return 1;
5237 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5238 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5239 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
5240 return 0;
5242 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
5243 return 0;
5245 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
5246 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5247 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5248 return 0;
5250 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
5251 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5252 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5253 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
5254 return 0;
5256 return 1;
5258 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5259 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
5260 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
5261 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
5262 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5263 return 0;
5265 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5266 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5267 return 0;
5269 return 1;
5271 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5272 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
5273 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
5274 one. */
5275 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5276 return 0;
5278 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5279 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5280 return 0;
5282 return 1;
5284 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5285 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
5286 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. Note
5287 that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order, so
5288 the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
5289 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
5290 return 0;
5292 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
5293 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5294 return 0;
5296 return 1;
5298 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5299 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
5300 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
5301 later operand. Note that multiple output operands are
5302 emitted in reverse order, so the conflicting ones are
5303 those with lower indices. */
5304 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5305 return 0;
5307 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
5308 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5309 return 0;
5311 return 1;
5313 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5314 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5315 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5316 return 0;
5318 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5319 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
5321 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5322 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5323 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5324 return 0;
5326 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
5328 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5329 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
5330 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.
5331 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
5332 so the conflicting ones are those with higher indices. */
5333 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
5334 return 0;
5336 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5337 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5338 return 0;
5340 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5341 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5342 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
5343 return 0;
5345 return 1;
5347 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5348 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5349 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
5350 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5351 return 0;
5353 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5354 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
5356 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5357 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
5359 default:
5360 gcc_unreachable ();
5364 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by the reload with
5365 the number RELOADNUM, is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
5367 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
5368 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
5369 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
5371 static int
5372 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int regno, int reloadnum)
5374 int opnum = rld[reloadnum].opnum;
5375 enum reload_type type = rld[reloadnum].when_needed;
5376 int i;
5378 /* See if there is a reload with the same type for this operand, using
5379 the same register. This case is not handled by the code below. */
5380 for (i = reloadnum + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
5382 rtx reg;
5383 int nregs;
5385 if (rld[i].opnum != opnum || rld[i].when_needed != type)
5386 continue;
5387 reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
5388 if (reg == NULL_RTX)
5389 continue;
5390 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (reg)][GET_MODE (reg)];
5391 if (regno >= REGNO (reg) && regno < REGNO (reg) + nregs)
5392 return 0;
5395 switch (type)
5397 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5398 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
5399 its value must reach the end. */
5400 return 1;
5402 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
5403 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
5404 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
5405 of fallthroughs. */
5407 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5408 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
5409 with anything else and everything comes later. */
5411 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5412 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5413 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5414 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
5415 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5416 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5417 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5418 return 0;
5420 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5421 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
5422 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5423 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5425 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5426 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5427 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
5428 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
5429 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
5430 conflict. */
5432 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5433 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5434 return 0;
5436 /* Reload register of reload with type RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5437 could be killed if the register is also used by reload with type
5438 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS, so check it. */
5439 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5440 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno))
5441 return 0;
5443 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5444 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5445 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
5446 return 0;
5448 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5449 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5450 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5451 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5452 return 0;
5454 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
5455 return 0;
5457 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5458 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5459 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5461 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5462 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
5463 both input and input address and we do not check for
5464 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
5465 would conflict. */
5467 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5468 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5469 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5470 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5471 return 0;
5473 /* ... fall through ... */
5475 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5476 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
5478 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5479 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5480 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5481 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5482 return 0;
5484 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5486 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5487 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5488 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5489 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5490 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5491 return 0;
5493 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5494 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5495 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5497 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5498 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
5499 we need only check for output addresses. */
5501 opnum = reload_n_operands;
5503 /* ... fall through ... */
5505 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5506 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5507 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5508 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
5509 only thing to check are later output addresses.
5510 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
5511 so the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
5512 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5513 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5514 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
5515 return 0;
5517 /* Reload register of reload with type RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
5518 could be killed if the register is also used by reload with type
5519 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS, so check it. */
5520 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
5521 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
5522 return 0;
5524 return 1;
5526 default:
5527 gcc_unreachable ();
5531 /* Like reload_reg_reaches_end_p, but check that the condition holds for
5532 every register in REG. */
5534 static bool
5535 reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (rtx reg, int reloadnum)
5537 unsigned int i;
5539 for (i = REGNO (reg); i < END_REGNO (reg); i++)
5540 if (!reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i, reloadnum))
5541 return false;
5542 return true;
5546 /* Returns whether R1 and R2 are uniquely chained: the value of one
5547 is used by the other, and that value is not used by any other
5548 reload for this insn. This is used to partially undo the decision
5549 made in find_reloads when in the case of multiple
5550 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads it converts all
5551 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reloads into RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5552 reloads. This code tries to avoid the conflict created by that
5553 change. It might be cleaner to explicitly keep track of which
5554 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload is associated with which
5555 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload, rather than to try to detect
5556 this after the fact. */
5557 static bool
5558 reloads_unique_chain_p (int r1, int r2)
5560 int i;
5562 /* We only check input reloads. */
5563 if (! rld[r1].in || ! rld[r2].in)
5564 return false;
5566 /* Avoid anything with output reloads. */
5567 if (rld[r1].out || rld[r2].out)
5568 return false;
5570 /* "chained" means one reload is a component of the other reload,
5571 not the same as the other reload. */
5572 if (rld[r1].opnum != rld[r2].opnum
5573 || rtx_equal_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5574 || rld[r1].optional || rld[r2].optional
5575 || ! (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5576 || reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in)))
5577 return false;
5579 /* The following loop assumes that r1 is the reload that feeds r2. */
5580 if (r1 > r2)
5582 int tmp = r2;
5583 r2 = r1;
5584 r1 = tmp;
5587 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i ++)
5588 /* Look for input reloads that aren't our two */
5589 if (i != r1 && i != r2 && rld[i].in)
5591 /* If our reload is mentioned at all, it isn't a simple chain. */
5592 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[i].in))
5593 return false;
5595 return true;
5598 /* The recursive function change all occurrences of WHAT in *WHERE
5599 to REPL. */
5600 static void
5601 substitute (rtx *where, const_rtx what, rtx repl)
5603 const char *fmt;
5604 int i;
5605 enum rtx_code code;
5607 if (*where == 0)
5608 return;
5610 if (*where == what || rtx_equal_p (*where, what))
5612 /* Record the location of the changed rtx. */
5613 substitute_stack.safe_push (where);
5614 *where = repl;
5615 return;
5618 code = GET_CODE (*where);
5619 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
5620 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5622 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
5624 int j;
5626 for (j = XVECLEN (*where, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
5627 substitute (&XVECEXP (*where, i, j), what, repl);
5629 else if (fmt[i] == 'e')
5630 substitute (&XEXP (*where, i), what, repl);
5634 /* The function returns TRUE if chain of reload R1 and R2 (in any
5635 order) can be evaluated without usage of intermediate register for
5636 the reload containing another reload. It is important to see
5637 gen_reload to understand what the function is trying to do. As an
5638 example, let us have reload chain
5640 r2: const
5641 r1: <something> + const
5643 and reload R2 got reload reg HR. The function returns true if
5644 there is a correct insn HR = HR + <something>. Otherwise,
5645 gen_reload will use intermediate register (and this is the reload
5646 reg for R1) to reload <something>.
5648 We need this function to find a conflict for chain reloads. In our
5649 example, if HR = HR + <something> is incorrect insn, then we cannot
5650 use HR as a reload register for R2. If we do use it then we get a
5651 wrong code:
5653 HR = const
5654 HR = <something>
5655 HR = HR + HR
5658 static bool
5659 gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int r1, int r2)
5661 /* Assume other cases in gen_reload are not possible for
5662 chain reloads or do need an intermediate hard registers. */
5663 bool result = true;
5664 int regno, n, code;
5665 rtx out, in, insn;
5666 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
5668 /* Make r2 a component of r1. */
5669 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in))
5671 n = r1;
5672 r1 = r2;
5673 r2 = n;
5675 gcc_assert (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in));
5676 regno = rld[r1].regno >= 0 ? rld[r1].regno : rld[r2].regno;
5677 gcc_assert (regno >= 0);
5678 out = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r1].mode, regno);
5679 in = rld[r1].in;
5680 substitute (&in, rld[r2].in, gen_rtx_REG (rld[r2].mode, regno));
5682 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
5683 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
5684 strip_paradoxical_subreg (&in, &out);
5686 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
5687 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
5688 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
5689 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
5690 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5691 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
5692 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5693 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
5695 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
5696 code = recog_memoized (insn);
5697 result = false;
5699 if (code >= 0)
5701 extract_insn (insn);
5702 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
5703 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after
5704 reload has completed. */
5705 result = constrain_operands (1);
5708 delete_insns_since (last);
5711 /* Restore the original value at each changed address within R1. */
5712 while (!substitute_stack.is_empty ())
5714 rtx *where = substitute_stack.pop ();
5715 *where = rld[r2].in;
5718 return result;
5721 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
5722 Return 0 otherwise.
5724 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
5726 static int
5727 reloads_conflict (int r1, int r2)
5729 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
5730 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
5731 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
5732 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
5734 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
5735 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
5736 return 1;
5738 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
5740 switch (r1_type)
5742 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5743 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5744 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5745 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
5746 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5747 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5748 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
5749 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
5751 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5752 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5753 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5755 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5756 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5757 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5759 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5760 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5761 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5763 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5764 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5765 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5767 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5768 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5769 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5770 && (!reloads_unique_chain_p (r1, r2)
5771 || !gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (r1, r2))));
5773 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5774 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5775 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
5777 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5778 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5779 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
5780 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
5781 && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
5783 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5784 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5785 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5786 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
5788 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5789 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
5791 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5792 return 1;
5794 default:
5795 gcc_unreachable ();
5799 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
5800 inherited from previous insns. */
5801 static char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
5803 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
5804 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
5805 static rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
5807 /* If nonzero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
5808 rather than using reload_in. */
5809 static rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
5811 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
5812 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
5813 static int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
5815 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the input mode. */
5816 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_input[MAX_RELOADS];
5818 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the output mode. */
5819 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_output[MAX_RELOADS];
5821 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
5822 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
5823 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
5825 static int
5826 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int start_regno, int regno, int opnum,
5827 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out,
5828 int reloadnum, int ignore_address_reloads)
5830 int time1;
5831 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
5832 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
5833 register with an output or input-output reload. */
5834 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
5835 int i;
5836 int copy = 0;
5838 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
5839 return 0;
5841 if (out == const0_rtx)
5843 copy = 1;
5844 out = NULL_RTX;
5847 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
5848 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
5849 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
5850 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
5851 monotonic.
5852 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
5853 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
5854 such reload type.
5855 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
5856 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
5857 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
5858 becomes live.
5859 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
5860 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
5861 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
5862 switch (type)
5864 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5865 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
5866 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
5867 break;
5868 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5869 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5870 break;
5871 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
5872 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
5873 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
5874 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
5875 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
5876 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
5877 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5878 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
5879 break;
5880 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5881 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
5882 break;
5883 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5884 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
5885 executes (inclusive). */
5886 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5887 break;
5888 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5889 /* opnum * 4 + 4
5890 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
5891 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5892 break;
5893 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5894 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
5895 is executed. */
5896 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5897 break;
5898 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5899 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
5900 break;
5901 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5902 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
5903 break;
5904 default:
5905 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5908 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5910 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
5911 if (reg && REG_P (reg)
5912 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
5913 <= hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (reg)][GET_MODE (reg)] - (unsigned) 1)
5914 && i != reloadnum)
5916 rtx other_input = rld[i].in;
5918 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
5919 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
5920 the same register. */
5921 if (true_regnum (reg) != start_regno)
5922 other_input = NULL_RTX;
5923 if (! other_input || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)
5924 || rld[i].out || out)
5926 int time2;
5927 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
5929 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5930 time2 = 0;
5931 break;
5932 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5933 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
5934 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
5935 by at most one - the first -
5936 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
5937 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
5938 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
5939 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5940 && ignore_address_reloads
5941 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
5942 Then the address address is still needed to store
5943 back the new address. */
5944 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5945 continue;
5946 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
5947 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5948 reloads go away. */
5949 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5950 && ignore_address_reloads
5951 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
5952 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5953 continue;
5954 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
5955 break;
5956 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5957 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5958 && ignore_address_reloads
5959 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5960 continue;
5961 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
5962 break;
5963 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5964 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
5965 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5966 break;
5967 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
5968 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
5969 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5970 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5971 && ignore_address_reloads
5972 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5973 continue;
5974 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5975 break;
5976 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5977 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
5978 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5979 break;
5980 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5981 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5982 break;
5983 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5984 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
5985 instruction is executed. */
5986 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5987 break;
5988 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
5989 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
5990 value. */
5991 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5992 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5993 && ignore_address_reloads
5994 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5995 continue;
5996 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
5997 break;
5998 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5999 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
6000 break;
6001 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6002 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
6003 like an output reload. */
6004 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (other_input, value))
6006 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
6007 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
6008 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
6009 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
6011 break;
6013 time2 = 1;
6014 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
6015 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
6016 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
6017 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
6018 if (out)
6019 return 0;
6020 break;
6021 default:
6022 return 0;
6024 if ((time1 >= time2
6025 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
6026 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)))
6027 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
6028 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
6029 return 0;
6034 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
6035 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
6036 return 0;
6038 return 1;
6041 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
6042 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
6043 may be used to load VALUE into it.
6045 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
6046 determine how many hard regs to test.
6048 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
6049 unless OUT is nonzero and these other reloads have to live while
6050 output reloads live.
6051 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
6052 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
6053 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
6055 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
6056 a reload does not conflict with itself.
6058 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
6059 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
6061 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
6062 register. */
6064 static int
6065 free_for_value_p (int regno, enum machine_mode mode, int opnum,
6066 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out, int reloadnum,
6067 int ignore_address_reloads)
6069 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
6070 while (nregs-- > 0)
6071 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, regno + nregs, opnum, type,
6072 value, out, reloadnum,
6073 ignore_address_reloads))
6074 return 0;
6075 return 1;
6078 /* Return nonzero if the rtx X is invariant over the current function. */
6079 /* ??? Actually, the places where we use this expect exactly what is
6080 tested here, and not everything that is function invariant. In
6081 particular, the frame pointer and arg pointer are special cased;
6082 pic_offset_table_rtx is not, and we must not spill these things to
6083 memory. */
6086 function_invariant_p (const_rtx x)
6088 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
6089 return 1;
6090 if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
6091 return 1;
6092 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
6093 && (XEXP (x, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx || XEXP (x, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx)
6094 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
6095 return 1;
6096 return 0;
6099 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
6100 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
6102 static int
6103 conflicts_with_override (rtx x)
6105 int i;
6106 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6107 if (reload_override_in[i]
6108 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, reload_override_in[i]))
6109 return 1;
6110 return 0;
6113 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
6114 and clear out reload R. */
6115 static void
6116 failed_reload (rtx insn, int r)
6118 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
6119 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6120 fatal_insn ("could not find a spill register", insn);
6122 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
6123 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
6124 error_for_asm (insn,
6125 "%<asm%> operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
6126 rld[r].in = 0;
6127 rld[r].out = 0;
6128 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
6129 rld[r].optional = 1;
6130 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
6133 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
6134 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
6135 successful. */
6136 static int
6137 set_reload_reg (int i, int r)
6139 /* regno is 'set but not used' if HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK doesn't use its first
6140 parameter. */
6141 int regno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
6142 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
6144 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
6145 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
6146 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
6148 regno = true_regnum (reg);
6150 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
6151 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
6152 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
6154 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
6155 if (rld[r].in)
6156 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
6157 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
6158 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
6159 We have already tested that for validity. */
6160 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
6161 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
6162 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
6163 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
6164 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
6165 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
6166 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
6168 /* The reg is OK. */
6169 last_spill_reg = i;
6171 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
6172 for this. */
6173 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
6174 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
6176 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
6177 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
6178 return 1;
6181 return 0;
6184 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
6185 LAST_RELOAD is nonzero if this is the last reload for the insn being
6186 processed.
6188 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
6190 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
6191 we didn't change anything. */
6193 static int
6194 allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int r,
6195 int last_reload)
6197 int i, pass, count;
6199 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
6200 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
6201 reg that some other reload needs.
6202 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
6203 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
6204 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
6205 for this insn.
6207 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
6208 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
6209 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
6210 by use of more alternatives. */
6212 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
6214 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
6215 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
6216 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
6218 We use three passes so we can first look for reload regs to
6219 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
6220 and only then use additional registers which are not "bad", then
6221 finally any register.
6223 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
6224 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
6225 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
6226 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
6227 That leaves none for C. */
6228 for (pass = 0; pass < 3; pass++)
6230 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
6231 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
6232 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
6233 of leapfrogging each other. */
6235 i = last_spill_reg;
6237 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
6239 int rclass = (int) rld[r].rclass;
6240 int regnum;
6242 i++;
6243 if (i >= n_spills)
6244 i -= n_spills;
6245 regnum = spill_regs[i];
6247 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
6248 rld[r].when_needed)
6249 || (rld[r].in
6250 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
6251 don't clobber the return register. */
6252 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
6253 && free_for_value_p (regnum, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
6254 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6255 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
6256 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regnum)
6257 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
6258 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
6259 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
6260 the ones we want to preserve. */
6261 && (pass
6262 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
6263 regnum)
6264 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6265 regnum))))
6267 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regnum][rld[r].mode];
6269 /* During the second pass we want to avoid reload registers
6270 which are "bad" for this reload. */
6271 if (pass == 1
6272 && ira_bad_reload_regno (regnum, rld[r].in, rld[r].out))
6273 continue;
6275 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
6276 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
6277 we would reject both of them. */
6278 if (force_group)
6279 nr = rld[r].nregs;
6280 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
6281 if (nr == 1)
6283 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
6284 if (force_group)
6285 continue;
6286 break;
6288 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
6289 are available here. */
6290 while (nr > 1)
6292 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
6293 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regno)
6294 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
6295 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
6296 rld[r].when_needed)))
6297 break;
6298 nr--;
6300 if (nr == 1)
6301 break;
6305 /* If we found something on the current pass, omit later passes. */
6306 if (count < n_spills)
6307 break;
6310 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
6311 if (count >= n_spills)
6312 return 0;
6314 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
6315 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
6317 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
6320 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
6321 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
6322 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
6324 static void
6325 choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *chain, rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx)
6327 int i;
6329 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6330 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
6332 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
6333 memset (reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
6334 memset (reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
6336 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
6337 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
6338 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
6339 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
6340 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
6341 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
6343 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
6345 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
6346 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
6347 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
6348 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
6349 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
6350 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
6351 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
6354 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
6356 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
6357 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
6358 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
6359 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
6360 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
6361 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
6364 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
6366 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
6368 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6369 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
6370 don't use it in another way. */
6371 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
6372 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
6373 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
6376 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6377 /* If X is not a subreg, return it unmodified. If it is a subreg,
6378 look up whether we made a replacement for the SUBREG_REG. Return
6379 either the replacement or the SUBREG_REG. */
6381 static rtx
6382 replaced_subreg (rtx x)
6384 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
6385 return find_replacement (&SUBREG_REG (x));
6386 return x;
6388 #endif
6390 /* Compute the offset to pass to subreg_regno_offset, for a pseudo of
6391 mode OUTERMODE that is available in a hard reg of mode INNERMODE.
6392 SUBREG is non-NULL if the pseudo is a subreg whose reg is a pseudo,
6393 otherwise it is NULL. */
6395 static int
6396 compute_reload_subreg_offset (enum machine_mode outermode,
6397 rtx subreg,
6398 enum machine_mode innermode)
6400 int outer_offset;
6401 enum machine_mode middlemode;
6403 if (!subreg)
6404 return subreg_lowpart_offset (outermode, innermode);
6406 outer_offset = SUBREG_BYTE (subreg);
6407 middlemode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg));
6409 /* If SUBREG is paradoxical then return the normal lowpart offset
6410 for OUTERMODE and INNERMODE. Our caller has already checked
6411 that OUTERMODE fits in INNERMODE. */
6412 if (outer_offset == 0
6413 && GET_MODE_SIZE (outermode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (middlemode))
6414 return subreg_lowpart_offset (outermode, innermode);
6416 /* SUBREG is normal, but may not be lowpart; return OUTER_OFFSET
6417 plus the normal lowpart offset for MIDDLEMODE and INNERMODE. */
6418 return outer_offset + subreg_lowpart_offset (middlemode, innermode);
6421 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
6422 into hard regs for this insn.
6423 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
6425 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
6426 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
6428 static void
6429 choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
6431 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6432 int i, j;
6433 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
6434 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
6435 int pass, win, inheritance;
6437 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
6439 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
6440 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
6441 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
6442 that provided the reload registers.
6444 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
6445 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
6446 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
6448 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6450 reload_order[j] = j;
6451 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != NULL_RTX)
6453 gcc_assert (REG_P (rld[j].reg_rtx)
6454 && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx));
6455 reload_spill_index[j] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
6457 else
6458 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6460 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
6462 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
6463 group_class
6464 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].rclass][(int) group_class];
6467 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
6470 if (n_reloads > 1)
6471 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
6473 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
6474 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
6475 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
6476 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
6477 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
6478 win = 0;
6479 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
6481 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6483 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
6484 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
6486 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
6487 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
6488 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
6489 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
6490 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
6492 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
6493 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
6494 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
6495 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
6496 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
6498 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
6499 that haven't been given registers yet. */
6501 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6503 int r = reload_order[j];
6504 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
6506 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
6507 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
6508 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
6509 continue;
6511 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
6512 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
6513 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
6514 around.
6515 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
6516 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
6517 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
6518 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
6519 && !MEM_P (rld[r].in)
6520 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
6521 continue;
6523 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
6524 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
6525 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
6526 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
6527 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
6528 are at the end of reload_order. */
6529 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
6530 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
6531 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
6532 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
6533 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
6534 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
6535 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
6536 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
6537 #endif
6539 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
6540 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
6541 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
6542 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
6543 for the groups.
6545 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
6546 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
6547 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
6548 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
6549 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
6550 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
6551 one of the loads in the case described above. */
6553 if (inheritance)
6555 int byte = 0;
6556 int regno = -1;
6557 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6558 rtx subreg = NULL_RTX;
6560 if (rld[r].in == 0)
6562 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in))
6564 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
6565 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
6567 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
6569 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
6570 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6572 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
6573 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)))
6575 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
6576 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6577 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in_reg);
6578 else
6580 subreg = rld[r].in_reg;
6581 byte = SUBREG_BYTE (subreg);
6583 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6585 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
6586 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg)) == RTX_AUTOINC
6587 && REG_P (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)))
6589 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6590 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6591 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
6593 #endif
6594 #if 0
6595 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
6596 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
6597 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
6598 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
6599 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)))
6600 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in);
6601 #endif
6603 if (regno >= 0
6604 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0
6605 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]))
6606 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + byte)
6607 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
6608 /* Verify that the register it's in can be used in
6609 mode MODE. */
6610 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6611 GET_MODE (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6612 mode)
6613 #endif
6616 enum reg_class rclass = rld[r].rclass, last_class;
6617 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
6619 i = REGNO (last_reg);
6620 byte = compute_reload_subreg_offset (mode,
6621 subreg,
6622 GET_MODE (last_reg));
6623 i += subreg_regno_offset (i, GET_MODE (last_reg), byte, mode);
6624 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
6626 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
6627 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
6628 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
6629 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rclass], i)
6630 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
6631 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
6632 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
6633 enough. */
6634 || ((register_move_cost (mode, last_class, rclass)
6635 < memory_move_cost (mode, rclass, true))
6636 && (secondary_reload_class (1, rclass, mode,
6637 last_reg)
6638 == NO_REGS)
6639 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6640 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, rclass,
6641 mode)
6642 #endif
6645 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6646 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
6648 && free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
6649 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6650 const0_rtx, r, 1))
6652 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
6653 registers still have their values intact. */
6654 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6655 int k;
6657 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
6658 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
6659 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
6660 break;
6662 if (k == nr)
6664 int i1;
6665 int bad_for_class;
6667 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
6668 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
6670 bad_for_class = 0;
6671 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6672 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6673 i+k);
6675 /* We found a register that contains the
6676 value we need. If this register is the
6677 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
6678 current insn, just mark it as a place to
6679 reload from since we can't use it as the
6680 reload register itself. */
6682 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
6683 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
6684 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
6685 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
6686 break;
6688 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
6689 || ! (free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode,
6690 rld[r].opnum,
6691 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6692 rld[r].out, r, 1))
6693 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
6694 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
6695 && rld[r].out
6696 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
6697 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
6698 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6699 && frame_pointer_needed
6700 && rld[r].out)
6701 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
6702 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
6703 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
6704 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
6705 || bad_for_class
6707 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
6708 register, stay with it - that leaves the
6709 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
6710 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
6711 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
6713 if (! rld[r].optional)
6715 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
6716 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6717 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6720 else
6722 int k;
6723 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
6724 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
6725 the insn. */
6726 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
6727 rld[r].opnum,
6728 rld[r].when_needed,
6729 rld[r].mode);
6730 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
6731 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6732 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6733 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6734 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
6735 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6736 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6737 i + k);
6744 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
6745 if (inheritance
6746 && rld[r].in != 0
6747 && ! reload_inherited[r]
6748 && rld[r].out == 0
6749 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
6750 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
6751 || REG_P (rld[r].in)
6752 || MEM_P (rld[r].in))
6753 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6754 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass, group_class)))
6755 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
6757 if (search_equiv)
6759 rtx equiv
6760 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].rclass,
6761 -1, NULL, 0, rld[r].mode);
6762 int regno = 0;
6764 if (equiv != 0)
6766 if (REG_P (equiv))
6767 regno = REGNO (equiv);
6768 else
6770 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
6771 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
6772 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
6773 there. */
6774 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG);
6775 regno = subreg_regno (equiv);
6776 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
6777 /* If we choose EQUIV as the reload register, but the
6778 loop below decides to cancel the inheritance, we'll
6779 end up reloading EQUIV in rld[r].mode, not the mode
6780 it had originally. That isn't safe when EQUIV isn't
6781 available as a spill register since its value might
6782 still be live at this point. */
6783 for (i = regno; i < regno + (int) rld[r].nregs; i++)
6784 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, i))
6785 equiv = 0;
6789 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
6790 and of the desired class. */
6791 if (equiv != 0)
6793 int regs_used = 0;
6794 int bad_for_class = 0;
6795 int max_regno = regno + rld[r].nregs;
6797 for (i = regno; i < max_regno; i++)
6799 regs_used |= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
6801 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6805 if ((regs_used
6806 && ! free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].mode,
6807 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6808 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
6809 || bad_for_class)
6810 equiv = 0;
6813 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
6814 equiv = 0;
6816 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
6817 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
6818 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
6819 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
6821 if (equiv != 0)
6822 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
6823 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
6824 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
6826 if (! rld[r].optional)
6827 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6828 equiv = 0;
6829 break;
6832 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
6833 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
6834 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
6835 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
6836 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
6838 if (equiv != 0)
6840 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 2))
6841 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6843 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6844 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6845 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6846 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6847 break;
6848 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6849 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6850 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6851 if (! rld[r].optional)
6852 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6853 /* Fall through. */
6854 default:
6855 equiv = 0;
6856 break;
6858 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 1))
6859 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6861 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6862 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6863 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6864 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6865 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6866 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6867 break;
6868 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6869 if (! rld[r].optional)
6870 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6871 /* Fall through. */
6872 default:
6873 equiv = 0;
6874 break;
6878 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
6879 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
6880 if (equiv != 0
6881 && (regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6882 || !frame_pointer_needed))
6884 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rld[r].mode];
6885 int k;
6886 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
6887 reload_spill_index[r] = regno;
6888 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6890 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
6891 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
6892 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
6893 might delete the store. */
6894 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
6895 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
6896 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
6897 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
6898 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6900 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
6901 if (i >= 0)
6903 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
6904 rld[r].when_needed,
6905 rld[r].mode);
6906 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6907 regno + k);
6913 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
6914 reload, we are done. */
6915 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
6916 continue;
6918 #if 0
6919 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
6920 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
6922 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
6923 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
6924 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
6925 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
6926 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
6927 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
6928 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
6929 turned off. */
6931 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
6933 int s = reload_order[i];
6935 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
6936 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
6937 || rld[s].optional)
6938 continue;
6940 if ((rld[s].rclass != rld[r].rclass
6941 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass,
6942 rld[s].rclass))
6943 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
6944 break;
6947 if (i == n_reloads)
6948 continue;
6950 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
6951 #endif
6954 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
6955 didn't get one yet. */
6956 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6958 int r = reload_order[j];
6960 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
6961 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
6962 continue;
6964 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
6965 optional. */
6966 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
6967 continue;
6969 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
6970 break;
6973 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
6974 if (j == n_reloads)
6976 win = 1;
6977 break;
6980 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
6983 if (! win)
6985 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
6986 to allocate with inheritance. */
6987 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6989 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
6990 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
6991 gcc_assert (chain->n_reloads == n_reloads);
6993 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6995 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
6996 continue;
6997 gcc_assert (chain->rld[i].when_needed == rld[i].when_needed);
6998 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
6999 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
7000 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
7001 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
7005 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
7006 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
7007 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
7008 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
7010 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
7011 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
7012 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
7013 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
7015 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7017 int r = reload_order[j];
7018 rtx check_reg;
7019 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7020 rtx tem;
7021 #endif
7022 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
7023 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
7024 else if (reload_override_in[r]
7025 && (REG_P (reload_override_in[r])
7026 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
7027 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
7028 else
7029 continue;
7030 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg), rld[r].mode,
7031 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
7032 (reload_inherited[r]
7033 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
7034 r, 1))
7036 if (pass)
7037 continue;
7038 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
7039 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
7041 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
7042 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
7043 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
7044 likewise for other reload types.
7045 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
7046 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
7047 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
7048 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
7049 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
7050 If we succeeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
7051 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
7052 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
7053 else if (rld[r].in
7054 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
7055 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in))
7057 if (pass)
7058 pass = 2;
7060 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7061 /* If we needed a memory location for the reload, we also have to
7062 remove its related reloads. */
7063 else if (rld[r].in
7064 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
7065 && (tem = replaced_subreg (rld[r].in), REG_P (tem))
7066 && REGNO (tem) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7067 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (tem)),
7068 rld[r].rclass, rld[r].inmode)
7069 && remove_address_replacements
7070 (get_secondary_mem (tem, rld[r].inmode, rld[r].opnum,
7071 rld[r].when_needed)))
7073 if (pass)
7074 pass = 2;
7076 #endif
7080 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
7081 actually override reload_in. */
7082 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7083 if (reload_override_in[j])
7084 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
7086 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been canceled or is
7087 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
7088 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
7089 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7090 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
7091 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
7092 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
7093 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
7095 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
7097 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
7098 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
7099 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
7100 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
7101 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
7104 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
7105 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7107 int r = reload_order[j];
7109 i = reload_spill_index[r];
7111 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
7112 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
7113 that we opted to ignore. */
7114 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)
7115 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
7117 int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
7118 int nr = 1;
7120 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7121 nr = hard_regno_nregs[nregno][rld[r].mode];
7123 while (--nr >= 0)
7124 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
7125 nregno + nr);
7127 if (i >= 0)
7128 add_to_hard_reg_set (&reg_is_output_reload, rld[r].mode, i);
7130 gcc_assert (rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
7131 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
7132 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INSN);
7137 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
7138 remove_address_replacements. */
7140 void
7141 deallocate_reload_reg (int r)
7143 int regno;
7145 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
7146 return;
7147 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
7148 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
7149 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
7150 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
7151 rld[r].mode);
7152 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
7155 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
7156 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7157 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
7158 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
7159 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7160 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7161 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7162 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7163 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7164 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
7165 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
7166 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
7168 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. Instructions
7169 must only be placed here if the associated reload register reaches
7170 the end of the instruction's reload sequence. */
7171 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7172 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
7174 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as an intermediate or scratch register
7175 of class NEW_CLASS with mode NEW_MODE. Or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg
7176 is nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
7177 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
7178 static bool
7179 reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
7180 enum reg_class new_class,
7181 enum machine_mode new_mode)
7184 rtx reg;
7186 for (reg = *reload_reg; reg; reg = alt_reload_reg, alt_reload_reg = 0)
7188 unsigned regno = REGNO (reg);
7190 if (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class], regno))
7191 continue;
7192 if (GET_MODE (reg) != new_mode)
7194 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, new_mode))
7195 continue;
7196 if (hard_regno_nregs[regno][new_mode]
7197 > hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)])
7198 continue;
7199 reg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg, new_mode);
7201 *reload_reg = reg;
7202 return true;
7204 return false;
7207 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as a scratch register for the reload
7208 pattern with insn_code ICODE, or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg is
7209 nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
7210 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
7211 static bool
7212 reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
7213 enum insn_code icode)
7216 enum reg_class new_class = scratch_reload_class (icode);
7217 enum machine_mode new_mode = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[2].mode;
7219 return reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (reload_reg, alt_reload_reg,
7220 new_class, new_mode);
7223 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
7224 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
7226 static void
7227 emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
7228 rtx old, int j)
7230 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7231 rtx reloadreg;
7232 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
7233 rtx oldequiv = 0;
7234 int special = 0;
7235 enum machine_mode mode;
7236 rtx *where;
7238 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
7239 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
7240 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
7241 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. This is also used to
7242 determine whether a secondary reload is needed. */
7243 if (reload_override_in[j]
7244 && (REG_P (rl->in_reg)
7245 || (GET_CODE (rl->in_reg) == SUBREG
7246 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rl->in_reg)))))
7248 oldequiv = old;
7249 old = rl->in_reg;
7251 if (oldequiv == 0)
7252 oldequiv = old;
7253 else if (REG_P (oldequiv))
7254 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
7255 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
7256 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
7258 reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j];
7259 mode = GET_MODE (reloadreg);
7261 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
7262 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7263 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7265 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
7266 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7267 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
7268 && REG_P (old)
7269 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
7270 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
7271 rl->out_reg)))
7272 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv), reloadreg);
7274 /* Encapsulate OLDEQUIV into the reload mode, then load RELOADREG from
7275 OLDEQUIV. */
7277 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
7278 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
7279 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
7280 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
7281 oldequiv = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv);
7283 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
7284 switch (rl->when_needed)
7286 case RELOAD_OTHER:
7287 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
7288 break;
7289 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
7290 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7291 break;
7292 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
7293 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7294 break;
7295 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
7296 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7297 break;
7298 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
7299 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7300 break;
7301 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
7302 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
7303 break;
7304 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
7305 where = &operand_reload_insns;
7306 break;
7307 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
7308 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
7309 break;
7310 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
7311 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
7312 break;
7313 default:
7314 gcc_unreachable ();
7317 push_to_sequence (*where);
7319 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
7320 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
7322 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
7323 incremented register can't be copied directly from
7324 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
7325 gcc_assert (rl->secondary_in_reload < 0);
7327 if (reload_inherited[j])
7328 oldequiv = reloadreg;
7330 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
7332 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
7333 special = 1;
7334 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
7335 inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out, rl->inc);
7338 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
7339 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
7340 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
7342 else if (optimize && REG_P (old)
7343 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7344 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
7345 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
7346 uses the same reg first. */
7347 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg)
7348 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg), rl->mode, rl->opnum,
7349 rl->when_needed, old, rl->out, j, 0))
7351 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
7352 while (temp && (NOTE_P (temp) || DEBUG_INSN_P (temp)))
7353 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
7354 if (temp
7355 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (temp)
7356 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
7357 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
7358 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
7359 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
7360 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
7361 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
7362 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1)
7364 rtx old = SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp));
7365 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
7366 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
7368 /* Verify that resulting insn is valid.
7370 Note that we have replaced the destination of TEMP with
7371 RELOADREG. If TEMP references RELOADREG within an
7372 autoincrement addressing mode, then the resulting insn
7373 is ill-formed and we must reject this optimization. */
7374 extract_insn (temp);
7375 if (constrain_operands (1)
7376 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7377 && ! find_reg_note (temp, REG_INC, reloadreg)
7378 #endif
7381 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
7382 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
7383 contain the previous destination. This is now
7384 invalid. */
7385 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))
7386 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7388 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
7389 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
7392 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
7393 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
7394 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
7395 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
7397 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (reloadreg);
7398 if (ira_conflicts_p)
7399 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
7400 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (old));
7401 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1, false);
7403 special = 1;
7405 /* Adjust any debug insns between temp and insn. */
7406 while ((temp = NEXT_INSN (temp)) != insn)
7407 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (temp))
7408 replace_rtx (PATTERN (temp), old, reloadreg);
7409 else
7410 gcc_assert (NOTE_P (temp));
7412 else
7414 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = old;
7419 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
7421 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
7422 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
7423 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
7424 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
7425 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
7426 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
7427 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
7428 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
7429 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
7430 output need secondary reload registers. */
7432 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7434 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
7435 rtx third_reload_reg = 0;
7436 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
7437 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7438 rtx real_old = old;
7439 rtx tmp;
7440 enum insn_code icode;
7441 enum insn_code tertiary_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7443 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
7444 and similarly for OLD.
7445 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
7446 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
7447 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
7448 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
7449 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
7450 equivalent constant.
7452 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
7453 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
7454 not in the right mode. */
7456 tmp = oldequiv;
7457 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7458 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7459 if (REG_P (tmp)
7460 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7461 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (tmp)) != 0
7462 || reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (tmp)) != 0))
7464 if (! reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (tmp))
7465 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7466 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
7467 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7468 else
7469 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (tmp));
7472 tmp = old;
7473 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7474 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7475 if (REG_P (tmp)
7476 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7477 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (tmp)) != 0
7478 || reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (tmp)) != 0))
7480 if (! reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (tmp))
7481 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7482 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
7483 real_old = rl->in;
7484 else
7485 real_old = reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (tmp));
7488 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7489 if (rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7491 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload;
7493 third_reload_reg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7494 tertiary_icode = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
7495 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7496 gcc_assert (rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_in_reload < 0);
7498 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
7500 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
7501 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
7503 secondary_reload_info sri, sri2;
7504 enum reg_class new_class, new_t_class;
7506 sri.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7507 sri.prev_sri = NULL;
7508 new_class
7509 = (enum reg_class) targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
7510 rl->rclass, mode,
7511 &sri);
7513 if (new_class == NO_REGS && sri.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7514 second_reload_reg = 0;
7515 else if (new_class == NO_REGS)
7517 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&second_reload_reg,
7518 third_reload_reg,
7519 (enum insn_code) sri.icode))
7521 icode = (enum insn_code) sri.icode;
7522 third_reload_reg = 0;
7524 else
7526 oldequiv = old;
7527 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7530 else if (sri.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7531 /* We currently lack a way to express this in reloads. */
7532 gcc_unreachable ();
7533 else
7535 sri2.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7536 sri2.prev_sri = &sri;
7537 new_t_class
7538 = (enum reg_class) targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
7539 new_class, mode,
7540 &sri);
7541 if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7543 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&second_reload_reg,
7544 third_reload_reg,
7545 new_class, mode))
7547 third_reload_reg = 0;
7548 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7550 else
7552 oldequiv = old;
7553 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7556 else if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7558 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7560 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7561 new_class, mode)
7562 && reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7563 ((enum insn_code)
7564 sri2.icode)))
7566 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7567 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7569 else
7571 oldequiv = old;
7572 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7575 else if (new_t_class != NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7577 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7579 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7580 new_class, mode)
7581 && reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7582 new_t_class, mode))
7584 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7585 tertiary_icode = (enum insn_code) sri2.icode;
7587 else
7589 oldequiv = old;
7590 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7593 else
7595 /* This could be handled more intelligently too. */
7596 oldequiv = old;
7597 real_oldequiv = real_old;
7602 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
7603 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
7604 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
7605 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
7606 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
7607 a MEM. */
7609 if (second_reload_reg)
7611 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7613 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7614 gcc_assert (!third_reload_reg);
7616 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
7617 second_reload_reg));
7618 special = 1;
7620 else
7622 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
7623 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
7624 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7626 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7627 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7628 third_reload_reg)));
7630 else if (third_reload_reg)
7632 gen_reload (third_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7633 rl->opnum,
7634 rl->when_needed);
7635 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, third_reload_reg,
7636 rl->opnum,
7637 rl->when_needed);
7639 else
7640 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7641 rl->opnum,
7642 rl->when_needed);
7644 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
7649 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
7651 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7653 if ((REG_P (oldequiv)
7654 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7655 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (oldequiv)) != 0
7656 || reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (oldequiv)) != 0))
7657 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
7658 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7659 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7660 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7661 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))) != 0)
7662 || (reg_equiv_constant (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))) != 0)))
7663 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv)
7664 && (targetm.preferred_reload_class (oldequiv,
7665 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg)))
7666 == NO_REGS)))
7667 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7668 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
7669 rl->when_needed);
7672 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
7673 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (insn, get_insns (), NULL);
7675 /* End this sequence. */
7676 *where = get_insns ();
7677 end_sequence ();
7679 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
7680 can see the actual register usage. */
7681 if (oldequiv_reg)
7682 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
7685 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
7686 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
7687 static void
7688 emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
7689 int j)
7691 rtx reloadreg;
7692 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7693 int special = 0;
7694 rtx old = rl->out;
7695 enum machine_mode mode;
7696 rtx p;
7697 rtx rl_reg_rtx;
7699 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7700 start_sequence ();
7701 else
7702 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7704 rl_reg_rtx = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j];
7705 mode = GET_MODE (rl_reg_rtx);
7707 reloadreg = rl_reg_rtx;
7709 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
7710 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
7711 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
7713 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
7715 rtx real_old = old;
7716 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7717 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload;
7719 if (REG_P (old) && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7720 && reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (old)) != 0)
7721 real_old = reg_equiv_mem (REGNO (old));
7723 if (secondary_reload_class (0, rl->rclass, mode, real_old) != NO_REGS)
7725 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
7726 reloadreg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7728 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
7729 or as an intermediate register. */
7730 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7732 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7733 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0);
7735 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
7736 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
7737 special = 1;
7739 else
7741 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
7742 register. */
7744 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
7745 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
7747 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7748 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0
7749 || rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_out_reload < 0);
7751 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
7752 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
7754 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7756 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7758 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
7759 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
7760 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
7762 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
7763 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
7764 RELOADREG. */
7765 strip_paradoxical_subreg (&real_old, &reloadreg);
7767 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7768 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7769 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7770 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
7771 special = 1;
7774 else
7776 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
7777 OUT later. */
7779 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7780 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7781 if (tertiary_reload >= 0)
7783 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7785 gen_reload (third_reloadreg, reloadreg,
7786 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7787 reloadreg = third_reloadreg;
7794 /* Output the last reload insn. */
7795 if (! special)
7797 rtx set;
7799 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
7800 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
7801 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
7802 || !REG_P (old)
7803 || !(set = single_set (insn))
7804 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
7805 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
7806 || !((REGNO (old) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7807 && regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode, 0)))
7808 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
7809 rl->when_needed);
7812 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
7813 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
7814 if (INSN_P (p))
7816 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
7818 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
7819 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
7820 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
7821 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
7822 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
7824 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl_reg_rtx, pat))
7826 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7827 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
7828 && set
7829 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx)
7831 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
7833 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
7834 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
7835 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
7836 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
7838 if (HARD_REGISTER_P (rl_reg_rtx))
7840 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7841 set = single_set (p);
7842 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
7843 register, the secondary reload does the actual
7844 store. */
7845 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
7846 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
7847 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
7848 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
7850 else if (s >= 0
7851 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx
7852 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
7854 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
7855 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
7856 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
7857 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
7858 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
7859 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
7860 rld[s].out = rl->out;
7861 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
7862 set = single_set (next);
7863 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
7864 && reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (s_reg, s))
7866 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
7867 REGNO (s_reg));
7868 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
7871 else if (reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (rl_reg_rtx, j))
7872 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl_reg_rtx)] = p;
7877 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7879 emit_insn (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7880 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7882 else
7883 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7885 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions)
7886 copy_reg_eh_region_note_forward (insn, get_insns (), NULL);
7888 end_sequence ();
7891 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
7892 and has the number J. */
7893 static void
7894 do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7896 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7897 rtx old = (rl->in && MEM_P (rl->in)
7898 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
7899 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
7901 if (old && reg_rtx)
7903 enum machine_mode mode;
7905 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
7906 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
7907 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
7908 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
7909 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
7910 by stripping some SUBREGs.
7911 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
7912 we can change that arbitrarily.
7914 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
7915 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
7916 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
7917 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
7918 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
7919 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
7920 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
7922 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
7923 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
7924 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
7925 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
7927 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
7928 to get a mode from something else.
7930 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
7931 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
7932 this operand, it overrides all others.
7934 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
7935 but it does the right things in those cases. */
7937 mode = GET_MODE (old);
7938 if (mode == VOIDmode)
7939 mode = rl->inmode;
7941 /* We cannot use gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing
7942 when REG_RTX has a multi-word mode. Note that REG_RTX must
7943 always be a REG here. */
7944 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
7945 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
7947 reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j] = reg_rtx;
7949 if (old != 0
7950 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
7951 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
7952 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
7953 && ! rtx_equal_p (reg_rtx, old)
7954 && reg_rtx != 0)
7955 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
7957 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
7958 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
7959 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
7960 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
7961 && MEM_P (rl->in)
7962 && MEM_P (rl->in_reg)
7963 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
7964 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
7965 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
7967 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
7968 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7969 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7971 if (optimize
7972 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
7973 && reg_rtx
7974 && REG_P (reg_rtx)
7975 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (reg_rtx)] != 0
7976 #if 0
7977 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
7978 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
7979 register of the wrong class. */
7980 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7981 #endif
7982 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
7983 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
7984 original pseudo. */
7985 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7986 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)], rl->out_reg)))
7987 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (reg_rtx), reg_rtx);
7990 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
7991 CHAIN and has the number J.
7992 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
7993 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
7994 static void
7995 do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7997 rtx note, old;
7998 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7999 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
8000 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
8001 store. */
8002 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
8003 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
8005 if (rl->out && reg_rtx)
8007 enum machine_mode mode;
8009 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
8010 See comments above (for input reloading). */
8011 mode = GET_MODE (rl->out);
8012 if (mode == VOIDmode)
8014 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
8015 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
8016 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
8017 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
8018 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in %<asm%>");
8019 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
8020 mode = word_mode;
8021 rl->out = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reg_rtx));
8023 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
8024 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
8026 reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j] = reg_rtx;
8028 if (pseudo
8029 && optimize
8030 && REG_P (pseudo)
8031 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
8032 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8033 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
8035 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
8036 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
8038 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
8039 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
8040 matches the pseudo. */
8041 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
8042 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
8043 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
8044 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
8045 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno, reg_rtx);
8048 old = rl->out_reg;
8049 if (old == 0
8050 || reg_rtx == 0
8051 || rtx_equal_p (old, reg_rtx))
8052 return;
8054 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
8055 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
8056 REG_UNUSED note. */
8057 if ((REG_P (old) || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
8058 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
8060 XEXP (note, 0) = reg_rtx;
8061 return;
8063 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
8064 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
8065 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (old))
8066 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
8067 SUBREG_REG (old))))
8069 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old), reg_rtx);
8070 return;
8072 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
8073 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
8074 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
8075 return;
8077 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
8078 gcc_assert (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn));
8080 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
8083 /* A reload copies values of MODE from register SRC to register DEST.
8084 Return true if it can be treated for inheritance purposes like a
8085 group of reloads, each one reloading a single hard register. The
8086 caller has already checked that (reg:MODE SRC) and (reg:MODE DEST)
8087 occupy the same number of hard registers. */
8089 static bool
8090 inherit_piecemeal_p (int dest ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8091 int src ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8092 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8094 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
8095 return (!REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (dest, mode, reg_raw_mode[dest])
8096 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (src, mode, reg_raw_mode[src]));
8097 #else
8098 return true;
8099 #endif
8102 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
8104 static void
8105 emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain)
8107 rtx insn = chain->insn;
8109 int j;
8111 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
8113 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
8114 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
8115 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
8116 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
8117 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
8118 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
8119 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
8120 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
8121 operand_reload_insns = 0;
8122 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
8124 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
8125 if (dump_file)
8127 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
8128 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
8131 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
8132 if (rld[j].reg_rtx && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx))
8134 unsigned int i;
8136 for (i = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i < END_REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i++)
8137 new_spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
8140 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
8141 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
8142 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
8143 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
8145 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
8147 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
8148 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
8151 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
8152 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
8153 the following reloads:
8155 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
8157 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
8159 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
8160 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
8161 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
8163 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
8165 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
8167 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
8169 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
8170 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
8171 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
8172 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
8173 output in descending order by reload number. */
8175 emit_insn_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
8176 emit_insn_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
8178 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
8180 emit_insn_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8181 emit_insn_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8182 emit_insn_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
8185 emit_insn_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
8186 emit_insn_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
8188 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
8190 rtx x = emit_insn_after (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
8191 x = emit_insn_after (output_address_reload_insns[j], x);
8192 x = emit_insn_after (output_reload_insns[j], x);
8193 emit_insn_after (other_output_reload_insns[j], x);
8196 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
8197 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
8198 can inherit the reloads.
8200 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
8201 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
8203 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
8205 int r = reload_order[j];
8206 int i = reload_spill_index[r];
8208 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
8209 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
8210 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
8211 being reloaded. */
8212 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
8213 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
8215 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
8217 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
8218 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
8220 if (REG_P (reg)
8221 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8222 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, REGNO (reg)))
8224 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
8226 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
8228 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
8230 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
8231 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
8236 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
8237 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
8238 that we opted to ignore. */
8240 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
8242 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)];
8243 int k;
8245 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
8246 of the value lives to the end. */
8247 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
8248 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, r))
8249 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
8251 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
8252 if (rld[r].out != 0
8253 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8254 || (rld[r].out_reg
8255 ? REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)
8256 /* The reload value is an auto-modification of
8257 some kind. For PRE_INC, POST_INC, PRE_DEC
8258 and POST_DEC, we record an equivalence
8259 between the reload register and the operand
8260 on the optimistic assumption that we can make
8261 the equivalence hold. reload_as_needed must
8262 then either make it hold or invalidate the
8263 equivalence.
8265 PRE_MODIFY and POST_MODIFY addresses are reloaded
8266 somewhat differently, and allowing them here leads
8267 to problems. */
8268 : (GET_CODE (rld[r].out) != POST_MODIFY
8269 && GET_CODE (rld[r].out) != PRE_MODIFY))))
8271 rtx reg;
8273 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
8274 if (reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (reg, r))
8276 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
8277 int regno = REGNO (reg);
8278 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
8279 rtx out = (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8280 ? rld[r].out
8281 : rld[r].out_reg
8282 ? rld[r].out_reg
8283 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
8284 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
8285 int out_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) ? 1
8286 : hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode]);
8287 bool piecemeal;
8289 spill_reg_store[regno] = new_spill_reg_store[regno];
8290 spill_reg_stored_to[regno] = out;
8291 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = reg;
8293 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno)
8294 && nregs == out_nregs
8295 && inherit_piecemeal_p (out_regno, regno, mode));
8297 /* If OUT_REGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
8298 one register. If it does, say what is in the
8299 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
8300 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
8301 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
8303 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
8304 for (k = 1; k < out_nregs; k++)
8305 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k]
8306 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
8308 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
8309 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
8311 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
8312 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
8313 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) || !piecemeal
8314 ? out_regno
8315 : out_regno + k);
8316 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
8317 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
8318 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
8319 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8320 regno + k);
8321 else
8322 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8323 regno + k);
8327 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
8328 something if there will not be an output reload for
8329 the register being reloaded. */
8330 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
8331 && rld[r].in != 0
8332 && ((REG_P (rld[r].in)
8333 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[r].in)
8334 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
8335 REGNO (rld[r].in)))
8336 || (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg)
8337 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
8338 REGNO (rld[r].in_reg))))
8339 && !reg_set_p (reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r], PATTERN (insn)))
8341 rtx reg;
8343 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r];
8344 if (reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (reg, r))
8346 enum machine_mode mode;
8347 int regno;
8348 int nregs;
8349 int in_regno;
8350 int in_nregs;
8351 rtx in;
8352 bool piecemeal;
8354 mode = GET_MODE (reg);
8355 regno = REGNO (reg);
8356 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
8357 if (REG_P (rld[r].in)
8358 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8359 in = rld[r].in;
8360 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
8361 in = rld[r].in_reg;
8362 else
8363 in = XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0);
8364 in_regno = REGNO (in);
8366 in_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) ? 1
8367 : hard_regno_nregs[in_regno][mode]);
8369 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] = reg;
8371 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno)
8372 && nregs == in_nregs
8373 && inherit_piecemeal_p (regno, in_regno, mode));
8375 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno))
8376 for (k = 1; k < in_nregs; k++)
8377 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno + k]
8378 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
8380 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
8381 recently done a store.
8382 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
8383 also have to be discarded. */
8384 if (! reload_inherited[r]
8385 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
8386 spill_reg_store[regno] = 0;
8388 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
8390 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
8391 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
8392 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) || !piecemeal
8393 ? in_regno
8394 : in_regno + k);
8395 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
8396 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
8397 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
8398 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8399 regno + k);
8400 else
8401 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8402 regno + k);
8408 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
8409 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
8410 deals with this problem. */
8412 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
8413 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
8414 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
8415 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here.
8416 Also do the same thing for RELOAD_OTHER constraints where the
8417 output is discarded. */
8418 if (i < 0
8419 && ((rld[r].out != 0
8420 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
8421 || (MEM_P (rld[r].out)
8422 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
8423 || (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].out_reg
8424 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
8426 rtx out = ((rld[r].out && REG_P (rld[r].out))
8427 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
8428 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
8429 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (out);
8431 /* REG_RTX is now set or clobbered by the main instruction.
8432 As the comment above explains, forget_old_reloads_1 only
8433 sees the original instruction, and there is no guarantee
8434 that the original instruction also clobbered REG_RTX.
8435 For example, if find_reloads sees that the input side of
8436 a matched operand pair dies in this instruction, it may
8437 use the input register as the reload register.
8439 Calling forget_old_reloads_1 is a waste of effort if
8440 REG_RTX is also the output register.
8442 If we know that REG_RTX holds the value of a pseudo
8443 register, the code after the call will record that fact. */
8444 if (rld[r].reg_rtx && rld[r].reg_rtx != out)
8445 forget_old_reloads_1 (rld[r].reg_rtx, NULL_RTX, NULL);
8447 if (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
8449 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
8451 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = 0;
8453 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
8454 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
8455 delete_output_reload. */
8456 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
8458 if (src_reg)
8460 if (reload_reg_rtx_reaches_end_p (src_reg, r))
8461 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
8462 else
8463 src_reg = NULL_RTX;
8465 else
8467 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the
8468 source reg from an input reload. */
8469 rtx set = single_set (insn);
8470 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
8472 int k;
8474 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
8475 store_insn = insn;
8476 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
8478 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
8480 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[k];
8481 break;
8486 if (src_reg && REG_P (src_reg)
8487 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8489 int src_regno, src_nregs, k;
8490 rtx note;
8492 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (src_reg) == mode);
8493 src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
8494 src_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[src_regno][mode];
8495 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
8496 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
8497 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
8498 notes, so just check both locations. */
8499 note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8500 if (! note && store_insn)
8501 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8502 for (k = 0; k < src_nregs; k++)
8504 spill_reg_store[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8505 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + k] = out;
8506 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + k] = out_regno;
8507 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8508 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + k);
8509 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + k);
8510 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (src_regno + k,
8511 mode))
8512 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8513 src_regno + k);
8514 else
8515 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8516 src_regno + k);
8517 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + k);
8518 if (note)
8519 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8520 else
8521 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8523 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = src_reg;
8524 /* We have to set reg_has_output_reload here, or else
8525 forget_old_reloads_1 will clear reg_last_reload_reg
8526 right away. */
8527 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
8528 out_regno);
8531 else
8533 int k, out_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode];
8535 for (k = 0; k < out_nregs; k++)
8536 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k] = 0;
8540 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
8543 /* Go through the motions to emit INSN and test if it is strictly valid.
8544 Return the emitted insn if valid, else return NULL. */
8546 static rtx
8547 emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx insn)
8549 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8550 int code;
8552 insn = emit_insn (insn);
8553 code = recog_memoized (insn);
8555 if (code >= 0)
8557 extract_insn (insn);
8558 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in its
8559 validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload has
8560 completed. */
8561 if (constrain_operands (1))
8562 return insn;
8565 delete_insns_since (last);
8566 return NULL;
8569 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
8570 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
8571 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
8573 Returns first insn emitted. */
8575 static rtx
8576 gen_reload (rtx out, rtx in, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
8578 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8579 rtx tem;
8580 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
8581 rtx tem1, tem2;
8582 #endif
8584 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
8585 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
8586 if (!strip_paradoxical_subreg (&in, &out))
8587 strip_paradoxical_subreg (&out, &in);
8589 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
8590 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
8591 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
8592 call emit_move_insn.
8594 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
8595 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
8596 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
8597 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
8598 we use a two insn sequence.
8600 Or we can be asked to reload an unary operand that was a fragment of
8601 an addressing mode, into a register. If it isn't recognized as-is,
8602 we try making the unop operand and the reload-register the same:
8603 (set reg:X (unop:X expr:Y))
8604 -> (set reg:Y expr:Y) (set reg:X (unop:X reg:Y)).
8606 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
8607 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
8608 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
8609 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
8610 be valid on machines that use 'o').
8612 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
8613 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
8614 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
8615 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
8616 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
8617 here. The one listed above seems to work.
8619 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
8621 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
8622 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
8623 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
8624 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
8625 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8626 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
8627 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8628 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
8630 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
8631 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
8632 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
8633 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
8635 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
8636 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
8638 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
8639 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
8640 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
8641 not valid than to dummy things up. */
8643 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
8644 enum insn_code code;
8646 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8647 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
8649 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
8650 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
8651 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
8652 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
8653 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
8654 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
8656 if (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8657 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
8658 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8660 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
8661 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
8663 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8664 if (insn)
8665 return insn;
8667 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
8669 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
8670 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
8671 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
8672 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
8673 reload OP1.
8675 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
8676 the reload register to the output register.
8678 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
8679 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
8680 we emit below. */
8682 code = optab_handler (add_optab, GET_MODE (out));
8684 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || MEM_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
8685 || (REG_P (op1)
8686 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8687 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
8688 && !insn_operand_matches (code, 2, op1)))
8689 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8691 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
8693 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
8694 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
8695 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
8697 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
8698 op1 = out;
8700 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
8701 if (insn)
8703 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
8704 set_dst_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in, out);
8705 return insn;
8708 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
8709 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
8711 gcc_assert (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (out, op0));
8712 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
8713 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
8714 set_dst_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in, out);
8717 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
8718 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
8719 else if ((tem1 = replaced_subreg (in), tem2 = replaced_subreg (out),
8720 (REG_P (tem1) && REG_P (tem2)))
8721 && REGNO (tem1) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8722 && REGNO (tem2) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8723 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (tem1)),
8724 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (tem2)),
8725 GET_MODE (out)))
8727 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
8728 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
8730 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
8731 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), reg_or_subregno (out));
8733 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
8734 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), reg_or_subregno (in));
8736 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
8737 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
8739 #endif
8740 else if (REG_P (out) && UNARY_P (in))
8742 rtx insn;
8743 rtx op1;
8744 rtx out_moded;
8745 rtx set;
8747 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8748 if (op1 != XEXP (in, 0))
8749 in = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in), op1);
8751 /* First, try a plain SET. */
8752 set = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8753 if (set)
8754 return set;
8756 /* If that failed, move the inner operand to the reload
8757 register, and try the same unop with the inner expression
8758 replaced with the reload register. */
8760 if (GET_MODE (op1) != GET_MODE (out))
8761 out_moded = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (op1), REGNO (out));
8762 else
8763 out_moded = out;
8765 gen_reload (out_moded, op1, opnum, type);
8767 insn
8768 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out,
8769 gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in),
8770 out_moded));
8771 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (insn);
8772 if (insn)
8774 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8775 return insn;
8778 fatal_insn ("failure trying to reload:", set);
8780 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
8781 else if (OBJECT_P (in) || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
8783 tem = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
8784 /* IN may contain a LABEL_REF, if so add a REG_LABEL_OPERAND note. */
8785 mark_jump_label (in, tem, 0);
8788 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
8789 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
8790 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
8791 #endif
8793 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
8794 else
8795 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8797 /* Return the first insn emitted.
8798 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
8799 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
8800 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
8801 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
8803 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
8806 /* Delete a previously made output-reload whose result we now believe
8807 is not needed. First we double-check.
8809 INSN is the insn now being processed.
8810 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
8811 the last output reload.
8812 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
8813 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input.
8814 NEW_RELOAD_REG is reload register that reload J is using for REG. */
8816 static void
8817 delete_output_reload (rtx insn, int j, int last_reload_reg, rtx new_reload_reg)
8819 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
8820 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
8821 int k;
8822 int n_occurrences;
8823 int n_inherited = 0;
8824 rtx i1;
8825 rtx substed;
8826 unsigned regno;
8827 int nregs;
8829 /* It is possible that this reload has been only used to set another reload
8830 we eliminated earlier and thus deleted this instruction too. */
8831 if (INSN_DELETED_P (output_reload_insn))
8832 return;
8834 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
8836 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
8837 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
8838 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (reg));
8840 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
8841 insn than it is inherited. */
8842 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
8844 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
8845 if (! reg2)
8846 continue;
8847 if (MEM_P (reg2) || reload_override_in[k])
8848 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
8849 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8850 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
8851 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
8852 #endif
8853 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
8854 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
8855 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
8857 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
8858 n_inherited++;
8859 else
8860 return;
8863 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
8864 if (CALL_P (insn) && CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn))
8865 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
8866 reg, 0);
8867 if (substed)
8868 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn),
8869 eliminate_regs (substed, VOIDmode,
8870 NULL_RTX), 0);
8871 for (i1 = reg_equiv_alt_mem_list (REGNO (reg)); i1; i1 = XEXP (i1, 1))
8873 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (XEXP (i1, 0), substed));
8874 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), XEXP (i1, 0), 0);
8876 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
8877 return;
8879 regno = REGNO (reg);
8880 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8881 nregs = 1;
8882 else
8883 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)];
8885 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
8886 anywhere between the store into it and here,
8887 and we're within the same basic block, then the value can only
8888 pass through the reload reg and end up here.
8889 Otherwise, give up--return. */
8890 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
8891 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
8893 if (NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK_P (i1))
8894 return;
8895 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) || CALL_P (i1))
8896 && refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + nregs, PATTERN (i1), NULL))
8898 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
8899 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
8900 while (NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
8902 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
8903 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
8905 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
8906 break;
8907 return;
8911 /* We will be deleting the insn. Remove the spill reg information. */
8912 for (k = hard_regno_nregs[last_reload_reg][GET_MODE (reg)]; k-- > 0; )
8914 spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8915 spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8918 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
8919 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some
8920 inaccuracies in the debugging information are acceptable.
8921 So we could just delete output_reload_insn. But in some cases
8922 we can improve the debugging information without sacrificing
8923 optimization - maybe even improving the code: See if the pseudo
8924 reg has been completely replaced with reload regs. If so, delete
8925 the store insn and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
8926 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
8927 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8928 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8929 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
8930 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
8932 rtx i2;
8934 /* We know that it was used only between here and the beginning of
8935 the current basic block. (We also know that the last use before
8936 INSN was the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never
8937 mind that.) Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
8938 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8940 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8942 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
8943 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
8944 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8945 continue;
8946 if (LABEL_P (i2) || JUMP_P (i2))
8947 break;
8948 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i2) || CALL_P (i2))
8949 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
8951 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
8952 know to be dead. */
8953 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8954 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8955 return;
8959 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. Note that this
8960 loop also takes care of deleting output_reload_insn. */
8961 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8963 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8965 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8967 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
8968 delete_insn (i2);
8970 if (LABEL_P (i2) || JUMP_P (i2))
8971 break;
8974 /* For the debugging info, say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
8975 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (new_reload_reg);
8976 if (ira_conflicts_p)
8977 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
8978 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (reg));
8979 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1, false);
8981 else
8983 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8984 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8988 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
8989 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
8990 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
8991 static void
8992 delete_address_reloads (rtx dead_insn, rtx current_insn)
8994 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
8995 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
8996 if (set)
8998 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
8999 if (MEM_P (dst))
9000 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
9002 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
9003 we can delete the matching adds. */
9004 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
9005 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
9006 if (! prev || ! next)
9007 return;
9008 set = single_set (next);
9009 set2 = single_set (prev);
9010 if (! set || ! set2
9011 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
9012 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
9013 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)))
9014 return;
9015 dst = SET_DEST (set);
9016 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
9017 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
9018 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
9019 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
9020 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
9021 return;
9022 delete_related_insns (prev);
9023 delete_related_insns (next);
9026 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
9027 static void
9028 delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx dead_insn, rtx x, rtx current_insn)
9030 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
9031 int i, j;
9032 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
9034 if (code != REG)
9036 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9037 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9039 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9040 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
9041 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9043 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9044 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
9045 current_insn);
9048 return;
9051 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
9052 return;
9054 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
9055 to inheritance. */
9056 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
9058 code = GET_CODE (prev);
9059 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
9060 return;
9061 if (!INSN_P (prev))
9062 continue;
9063 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
9064 break;
9065 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
9066 return;
9068 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
9069 return;
9070 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
9071 set = single_set (prev);
9072 if (! set)
9073 return;
9074 dst = SET_DEST (set);
9075 if (!REG_P (dst)
9076 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
9077 return;
9078 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
9080 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
9081 it might have been inherited. */
9082 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
9084 if (LABEL_P (i2))
9085 break;
9086 if (! INSN_P (i2))
9087 continue;
9088 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
9090 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
9091 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
9092 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
9093 referenced. */
9094 if (i2 == current_insn)
9096 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9097 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
9098 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
9099 return;
9100 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9101 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
9102 break;
9103 if (j >= 0)
9104 break;
9106 return;
9108 if (JUMP_P (i2))
9109 break;
9110 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
9111 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
9112 have to check the reloads. */
9113 if (i2 == current_insn)
9115 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9116 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
9117 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
9118 return;
9119 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
9120 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
9121 block needs any of the classes containing DST - see
9122 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
9123 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
9125 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
9126 break;
9129 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
9130 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
9131 delete_insn (prev);
9134 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
9135 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
9136 is a register or memory location;
9137 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
9138 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
9140 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
9141 This cannot be deduced from VALUE. */
9143 static void
9144 inc_for_reload (rtx reloadreg, rtx in, rtx value, int inc_amount)
9146 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
9147 rtx incloc = find_replacement (&XEXP (value, 0));
9148 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
9149 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC
9150 || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY);
9151 rtx last;
9152 rtx inc;
9153 rtx add_insn;
9154 int code;
9155 rtx real_in = in == value ? incloc : in;
9157 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
9158 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were nonzero,
9159 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
9160 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
9161 if (REG_P (incloc))
9162 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
9164 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_MODIFY || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY)
9166 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == PLUS);
9167 inc = find_replacement (&XEXP (XEXP (value, 1), 1));
9169 else
9171 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
9172 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
9174 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
9177 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
9178 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
9179 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
9181 if (in == value)
9183 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
9184 that in gen_reload. */
9186 last = get_last_insn ();
9187 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
9188 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
9189 incloc, inc)));
9191 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
9192 if (code >= 0)
9194 extract_insn (add_insn);
9195 if (constrain_operands (1))
9197 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
9198 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
9199 be used as an address. */
9201 if (! post)
9202 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
9203 return;
9206 delete_insns_since (last);
9209 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
9210 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
9211 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
9212 there, then save back. */
9214 if (! post)
9216 if (in != reloadreg)
9217 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
9218 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9219 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
9221 else
9223 /* Postincrement.
9224 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
9225 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
9226 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
9228 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
9229 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
9230 the original value. */
9232 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9233 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
9234 if (CONST_INT_P (inc))
9235 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg,
9236 gen_int_mode (-INTVAL (inc),
9237 GET_MODE (reloadreg))));
9238 else
9239 emit_insn (gen_sub2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
9243 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
9244 static void
9245 add_auto_inc_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
9247 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
9248 const char *fmt;
9249 int i, j;
9251 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
9253 add_reg_note (insn, REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
9254 return;
9257 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
9258 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
9259 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9261 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
9262 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
9263 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
9264 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
9265 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
9268 #endif